OpenCores
URL https://opencores.org/ocsvn/openrisc/openrisc/trunk

Subversion Repositories openrisc

[/] [openrisc/] [trunk/] [gnu-stable/] [binutils-2.20.1/] [bfd/] [elf32-xtensa.c] - Blame information for rev 843

Go to most recent revision | Details | Compare with Previous | View Log

Line No. Rev Author Line
1 205 julius
/* Xtensa-specific support for 32-bit ELF.
2
   Copyright 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
3
   Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
 
5
   This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
 
7
   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
8
   modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
9
   published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the
10
   License, or (at your option) any later version.
11
 
12
   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
13
   WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14
   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
15
   General Public License for more details.
16
 
17
   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18
   along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19
   Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
20
   02110-1301, USA.  */
21
 
22
#include "sysdep.h"
23
#include "bfd.h"
24
 
25
#include <stdarg.h>
26
#include <strings.h>
27
 
28
#include "bfdlink.h"
29
#include "libbfd.h"
30
#include "elf-bfd.h"
31
#include "elf/xtensa.h"
32
#include "xtensa-isa.h"
33
#include "xtensa-config.h"
34
 
35
#define XTENSA_NO_NOP_REMOVAL 0
36
 
37
/* Local helper functions.  */
38
 
39
static bfd_boolean add_extra_plt_sections (struct bfd_link_info *, int);
40
static char *vsprint_msg (const char *, const char *, int, ...) ATTRIBUTE_PRINTF(2,4);
41
static bfd_reloc_status_type bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc
42
  (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
43
static bfd_boolean do_fix_for_relocatable_link
44
  (Elf_Internal_Rela *, bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *);
45
static void do_fix_for_final_link
46
  (Elf_Internal_Rela *, bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, bfd_vma *);
47
 
48
/* Local functions to handle Xtensa configurability.  */
49
 
50
static bfd_boolean is_indirect_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode);
51
static bfd_boolean is_direct_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode);
52
static bfd_boolean is_windowed_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode);
53
static xtensa_opcode get_const16_opcode (void);
54
static xtensa_opcode get_l32r_opcode (void);
55
static bfd_vma l32r_offset (bfd_vma, bfd_vma);
56
static int get_relocation_opnd (xtensa_opcode, int);
57
static int get_relocation_slot (int);
58
static xtensa_opcode get_relocation_opcode
59
  (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
60
static bfd_boolean is_l32r_relocation
61
  (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
62
static bfd_boolean is_alt_relocation (int);
63
static bfd_boolean is_operand_relocation (int);
64
static bfd_size_type insn_decode_len
65
  (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_size_type);
66
static xtensa_opcode insn_decode_opcode
67
  (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_size_type, int);
68
static bfd_boolean check_branch_target_aligned
69
  (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_vma, bfd_vma);
70
static bfd_boolean check_loop_aligned
71
  (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_vma, bfd_vma);
72
static bfd_boolean check_branch_target_aligned_address (bfd_vma, int);
73
static bfd_size_type get_asm_simplify_size
74
  (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_size_type);
75
 
76
/* Functions for link-time code simplifications.  */
77
 
78
static bfd_reloc_status_type elf_xtensa_do_asm_simplify
79
  (bfd_byte *, bfd_vma, bfd_vma, char **);
80
static bfd_reloc_status_type contract_asm_expansion
81
  (bfd_byte *, bfd_vma, Elf_Internal_Rela *, char **);
82
static xtensa_opcode swap_callx_for_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode);
83
static xtensa_opcode get_expanded_call_opcode (bfd_byte *, int, bfd_boolean *);
84
 
85
/* Access to internal relocations, section contents and symbols.  */
86
 
87
static Elf_Internal_Rela *retrieve_internal_relocs
88
  (bfd *, asection *, bfd_boolean);
89
static void pin_internal_relocs (asection *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
90
static void release_internal_relocs (asection *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
91
static bfd_byte *retrieve_contents (bfd *, asection *, bfd_boolean);
92
static void pin_contents (asection *, bfd_byte *);
93
static void release_contents (asection *, bfd_byte *);
94
static Elf_Internal_Sym *retrieve_local_syms (bfd *);
95
 
96
/* Miscellaneous utility functions.  */
97
 
98
static asection *elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (struct bfd_link_info *, int);
99
static asection *elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (struct bfd_link_info *, int);
100
static asection *get_elf_r_symndx_section (bfd *, unsigned long);
101
static struct elf_link_hash_entry *get_elf_r_symndx_hash_entry
102
  (bfd *, unsigned long);
103
static bfd_vma get_elf_r_symndx_offset (bfd *, unsigned long);
104
static bfd_boolean is_reloc_sym_weak (bfd *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
105
static bfd_boolean pcrel_reloc_fits (xtensa_opcode, int, bfd_vma, bfd_vma);
106
static bfd_boolean xtensa_is_property_section (asection *);
107
static bfd_boolean xtensa_is_insntable_section (asection *);
108
static bfd_boolean xtensa_is_littable_section (asection *);
109
static bfd_boolean xtensa_is_proptable_section (asection *);
110
static int internal_reloc_compare (const void *, const void *);
111
static int internal_reloc_matches (const void *, const void *);
112
static asection *xtensa_get_property_section (asection *, const char *);
113
extern asection *xtensa_make_property_section (asection *, const char *);
114
static flagword xtensa_get_property_predef_flags (asection *);
115
 
116
/* Other functions called directly by the linker.  */
117
 
118
typedef void (*deps_callback_t)
119
  (asection *, bfd_vma, asection *, bfd_vma, void *);
120
extern bfd_boolean xtensa_callback_required_dependence
121
  (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *, deps_callback_t, void *);
122
 
123
 
124
/* Globally visible flag for choosing size optimization of NOP removal
125
   instead of branch-target-aware minimization for NOP removal.
126
   When nonzero, narrow all instructions and remove all NOPs possible
127
   around longcall expansions.  */
128
 
129
int elf32xtensa_size_opt;
130
 
131
 
132
/* The "new_section_hook" is used to set up a per-section
133
   "xtensa_relax_info" data structure with additional information used
134
   during relaxation.  */
135
 
136
typedef struct xtensa_relax_info_struct xtensa_relax_info;
137
 
138
 
139
/* The GNU tools do not easily allow extending interfaces to pass around
140
   the pointer to the Xtensa ISA information, so instead we add a global
141
   variable here (in BFD) that can be used by any of the tools that need
142
   this information. */
143
 
144
xtensa_isa xtensa_default_isa;
145
 
146
 
147
/* When this is true, relocations may have been modified to refer to
148
   symbols from other input files.  The per-section list of "fix"
149
   records needs to be checked when resolving relocations.  */
150
 
151
static bfd_boolean relaxing_section = FALSE;
152
 
153
/* When this is true, during final links, literals that cannot be
154
   coalesced and their relocations may be moved to other sections.  */
155
 
156
int elf32xtensa_no_literal_movement = 1;
157
 
158
 
159
static reloc_howto_type elf_howto_table[] =
160
{
161
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_NONE, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
162
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_NONE",
163
         FALSE, 0, 0, FALSE),
164
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_32, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
165
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_32",
166
         TRUE, 0xffffffff, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
167
 
168
  /* Replace a 32-bit value with a value from the runtime linker (only
169
     used by linker-generated stub functions).  The r_addend value is
170
     special: 1 means to substitute a pointer to the runtime linker's
171
     dynamic resolver function; 2 means to substitute the link map for
172
     the shared object.  */
173
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_RTLD, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
174
         NULL, "R_XTENSA_RTLD", FALSE, 0, 0, FALSE),
175
 
176
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
177
         bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT",
178
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
179
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
180
         bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT",
181
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
182
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_RELATIVE, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
183
         bfd_elf_generic_reloc, "R_XTENSA_RELATIVE",
184
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
185
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_PLT, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
186
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_PLT",
187
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
188
 
189
  EMPTY_HOWTO (7),
190
 
191
  /* Old relocations for backward compatibility.  */
192
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_OP0, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
193
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_OP0", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
194
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_OP1, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
195
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_OP1", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
196
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_OP2, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
197
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_OP2", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
198
 
199
  /* Assembly auto-expansion.  */
200
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
201
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
202
  /* Relax assembly auto-expansion.  */
203
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
204
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
205
 
206
  EMPTY_HOWTO (13),
207
 
208
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_32_PCREL, 0, 2, 32, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
209
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_32_PCREL",
210
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, TRUE),
211
 
212
  /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy.  */
213
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 2, 0, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
214
         NULL, "R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT",
215
         FALSE, 0, 0, FALSE),
216
  /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage.  */
217
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 2, 0, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
218
         _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn, "R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY",
219
         FALSE, 0, 0, FALSE),
220
 
221
  /* Relocations for supporting difference of symbols.  */
222
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_DIFF8, 0, 0, 8, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
223
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_DIFF8", FALSE, 0, 0xff, FALSE),
224
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_DIFF16, 0, 1, 16, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
225
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_DIFF16", FALSE, 0, 0xffff, FALSE),
226
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_DIFF32, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_bitfield,
227
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_DIFF32", FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
228
 
229
  /* General immediate operand relocations.  */
230
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
231
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
232
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT1_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
233
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT1_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
234
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT2_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
235
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT2_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
236
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT3_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
237
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT3_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
238
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT4_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
239
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT4_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
240
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT5_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
241
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT5_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
242
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT6_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
243
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT6_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
244
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT7_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
245
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT7_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
246
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT8_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
247
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT8_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
248
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT9_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
249
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT9_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
250
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT10_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
251
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT10_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
252
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT11_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
253
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT11_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
254
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT12_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
255
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT12_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
256
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT13_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
257
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT13_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
258
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT14_OP, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
259
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT14_OP", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
260
 
261
  /* "Alternate" relocations.  The meaning of these is opcode-specific.  */
262
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
263
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
264
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT1_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
265
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT1_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
266
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT2_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
267
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT2_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
268
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT3_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
269
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT3_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
270
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT4_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
271
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT4_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
272
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT5_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
273
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT5_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
274
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT6_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
275
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT6_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
276
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT7_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
277
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT7_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
278
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT8_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
279
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT8_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
280
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT9_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
281
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT9_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
282
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT10_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
283
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT10_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
284
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT11_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
285
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT11_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
286
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT12_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
287
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT12_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
288
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT13_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
289
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT13_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
290
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT, 0, 0, 0, TRUE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
291
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT", FALSE, 0, 0, TRUE),
292
 
293
  /* TLS relocations.  */
294
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
295
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN",
296
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
297
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
298
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG",
299
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
300
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
301
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF",
302
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
303
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF, 0, 2, 32, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
304
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF",
305
         FALSE, 0, 0xffffffff, FALSE),
306
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
307
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC",
308
         FALSE, 0, 0, FALSE),
309
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
310
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG",
311
         FALSE, 0, 0, FALSE),
312
  HOWTO (R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, 0, complain_overflow_dont,
313
         bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc, "R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL",
314
         FALSE, 0, 0, FALSE),
315
};
316
 
317
#if DEBUG_GEN_RELOC
318
#define TRACE(str) \
319
  fprintf (stderr, "Xtensa bfd reloc lookup %d (%s)\n", code, str)
320
#else
321
#define TRACE(str)
322
#endif
323
 
324
static reloc_howto_type *
325
elf_xtensa_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
326
                              bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
327
{
328
  switch (code)
329
    {
330
    case BFD_RELOC_NONE:
331
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_NONE");
332
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_NONE ];
333
 
334
    case BFD_RELOC_32:
335
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_32");
336
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_32 ];
337
 
338
    case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL:
339
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL");
340
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_32_PCREL ];
341
 
342
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF8:
343
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF8");
344
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_DIFF8 ];
345
 
346
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF16:
347
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF16");
348
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_DIFF16 ];
349
 
350
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF32:
351
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_DIFF32");
352
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_DIFF32 ];
353
 
354
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_RTLD:
355
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_RTLD");
356
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_RTLD ];
357
 
358
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT:
359
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT");
360
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT ];
361
 
362
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT:
363
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT");
364
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT ];
365
 
366
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_RELATIVE:
367
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_RELATIVE");
368
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_RELATIVE ];
369
 
370
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_PLT:
371
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_PLT");
372
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_PLT ];
373
 
374
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP0:
375
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP0");
376
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_OP0 ];
377
 
378
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP1:
379
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP1");
380
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_OP1 ];
381
 
382
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP2:
383
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_OP2");
384
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_OP2 ];
385
 
386
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND:
387
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND");
388
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND ];
389
 
390
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY:
391
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY");
392
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY ];
393
 
394
    case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT:
395
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT");
396
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT ];
397
 
398
    case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY:
399
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY");
400
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY ];
401
 
402
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN:
403
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN");
404
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN ];
405
 
406
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG:
407
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG");
408
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG ];
409
 
410
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF:
411
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF");
412
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF ];
413
 
414
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF:
415
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF");
416
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF ];
417
 
418
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
419
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC");
420
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC ];
421
 
422
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
423
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_ARG");
424
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG ];
425
 
426
    case BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
427
      TRACE ("BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_TLS_CALL");
428
      return &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL ];
429
 
430
    default:
431
      if (code >= BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP
432
          && code <= BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT14_OP)
433
        {
434
          unsigned n = (R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP +
435
                        (code - BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP));
436
          return &elf_howto_table[n];
437
        }
438
 
439
      if (code >= BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT
440
          && code <= BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT)
441
        {
442
          unsigned n = (R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT +
443
                        (code - BFD_RELOC_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT));
444
          return &elf_howto_table[n];
445
        }
446
 
447
      break;
448
    }
449
 
450
  TRACE ("Unknown");
451
  return NULL;
452
}
453
 
454
static reloc_howto_type *
455
elf_xtensa_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
456
                              const char *r_name)
457
{
458
  unsigned int i;
459
 
460
  for (i = 0; i < sizeof (elf_howto_table) / sizeof (elf_howto_table[0]); i++)
461
    if (elf_howto_table[i].name != NULL
462
        && strcasecmp (elf_howto_table[i].name, r_name) == 0)
463
      return &elf_howto_table[i];
464
 
465
  return NULL;
466
}
467
 
468
 
469
/* Given an ELF "rela" relocation, find the corresponding howto and record
470
   it in the BFD internal arelent representation of the relocation.  */
471
 
472
static void
473
elf_xtensa_info_to_howto_rela (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
474
                               arelent *cache_ptr,
475
                               Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
476
{
477
  unsigned int r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
478
 
479
  BFD_ASSERT (r_type < (unsigned int) R_XTENSA_max);
480
  cache_ptr->howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
481
}
482
 
483
 
484
/* Functions for the Xtensa ELF linker.  */
485
 
486
/* The name of the dynamic interpreter.  This is put in the .interp
487
   section.  */
488
 
489
#define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/lib/ld.so"
490
 
491
/* The size in bytes of an entry in the procedure linkage table.
492
   (This does _not_ include the space for the literals associated with
493
   the PLT entry.) */
494
 
495
#define PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 16
496
 
497
/* For _really_ large PLTs, we may need to alternate between literals
498
   and code to keep the literals within the 256K range of the L32R
499
   instructions in the code.  It's unlikely that anyone would ever need
500
   such a big PLT, but an arbitrary limit on the PLT size would be bad.
501
   Thus, we split the PLT into chunks.  Since there's very little
502
   overhead (2 extra literals) for each chunk, the chunk size is kept
503
   small so that the code for handling multiple chunks get used and
504
   tested regularly.  With 254 entries, there are 1K of literals for
505
   each chunk, and that seems like a nice round number.  */
506
 
507
#define PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK 254
508
 
509
/* PLT entries are actually used as stub functions for lazy symbol
510
   resolution.  Once the symbol is resolved, the stub function is never
511
   invoked.  Note: the 32-byte frame size used here cannot be changed
512
   without a corresponding change in the runtime linker.  */
513
 
514
static const bfd_byte elf_xtensa_be_plt_entry[PLT_ENTRY_SIZE] =
515
{
516
  0x6c, 0x10, 0x04,     /* entry sp, 32 */
517
  0x18, 0x00, 0x00,     /* l32r  a8, [got entry for rtld's resolver] */
518
  0x1a, 0x00, 0x00,     /* l32r  a10, [got entry for rtld's link map] */
519
  0x1b, 0x00, 0x00,     /* l32r  a11, [literal for reloc index] */
520
  0x0a, 0x80, 0x00,     /* jx    a8 */
521
 
522
};
523
 
524
static const bfd_byte elf_xtensa_le_plt_entry[PLT_ENTRY_SIZE] =
525
{
526
  0x36, 0x41, 0x00,     /* entry sp, 32 */
527
  0x81, 0x00, 0x00,     /* l32r  a8, [got entry for rtld's resolver] */
528
  0xa1, 0x00, 0x00,     /* l32r  a10, [got entry for rtld's link map] */
529
  0xb1, 0x00, 0x00,     /* l32r  a11, [literal for reloc index] */
530
  0xa0, 0x08, 0x00,     /* jx    a8 */
531
 
532
};
533
 
534
/* The size of the thread control block.  */
535
#define TCB_SIZE        8
536
 
537
struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry
538
{
539
  struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
540
 
541
  bfd_signed_vma tlsfunc_refcount;
542
 
543
#define GOT_UNKNOWN     0
544
#define GOT_NORMAL      1
545
#define GOT_TLS_GD      2       /* global or local dynamic */
546
#define GOT_TLS_IE      4       /* initial or local exec */
547
#define GOT_TLS_ANY     (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_IE)
548
  unsigned char tls_type;
549
};
550
 
551
#define elf_xtensa_hash_entry(ent) ((struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *)(ent))
552
 
553
struct elf_xtensa_obj_tdata
554
{
555
  struct elf_obj_tdata root;
556
 
557
  /* tls_type for each local got entry.  */
558
  char *local_got_tls_type;
559
 
560
  bfd_signed_vma *local_tlsfunc_refcounts;
561
};
562
 
563
#define elf_xtensa_tdata(abfd) \
564
  ((struct elf_xtensa_obj_tdata *) (abfd)->tdata.any)
565
 
566
#define elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type(abfd) \
567
  (elf_xtensa_tdata (abfd)->local_got_tls_type)
568
 
569
#define elf_xtensa_local_tlsfunc_refcounts(abfd) \
570
  (elf_xtensa_tdata (abfd)->local_tlsfunc_refcounts)
571
 
572
#define is_xtensa_elf(bfd) \
573
  (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
574
   && elf_tdata (bfd) != NULL \
575
   && elf_object_id (bfd) == XTENSA_ELF_TDATA)
576
 
577
static bfd_boolean
578
elf_xtensa_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
579
{
580
  return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_xtensa_obj_tdata),
581
                                  XTENSA_ELF_TDATA);
582
}
583
 
584
/* Xtensa ELF linker hash table.  */
585
 
586
struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table
587
{
588
  struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
589
 
590
  /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections.  */
591
  asection *sgot;
592
  asection *sgotplt;
593
  asection *srelgot;
594
  asection *splt;
595
  asection *srelplt;
596
  asection *sgotloc;
597
  asection *spltlittbl;
598
 
599
  /* Total count of PLT relocations seen during check_relocs.
600
     The actual PLT code must be split into multiple sections and all
601
     the sections have to be created before size_dynamic_sections,
602
     where we figure out the exact number of PLT entries that will be
603
     needed.  It is OK if this count is an overestimate, e.g., some
604
     relocations may be removed by GC.  */
605
  int plt_reloc_count;
606
 
607
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *tlsbase;
608
};
609
 
610
/* Get the Xtensa ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure.  */
611
 
612
#define elf_xtensa_hash_table(p) \
613
  ((struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash))
614
 
615
/* Create an entry in an Xtensa ELF linker hash table.  */
616
 
617
static struct bfd_hash_entry *
618
elf_xtensa_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
619
                              struct bfd_hash_table *table,
620
                              const char *string)
621
{
622
  /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
623
     subclass.  */
624
  if (entry == NULL)
625
    {
626
      entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
627
                                 sizeof (struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry));
628
      if (entry == NULL)
629
        return entry;
630
    }
631
 
632
  /* Call the allocation method of the superclass.  */
633
  entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
634
  if (entry != NULL)
635
    {
636
      struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *eh = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (entry);
637
      eh->tlsfunc_refcount = 0;
638
      eh->tls_type = GOT_UNKNOWN;
639
    }
640
 
641
  return entry;
642
}
643
 
644
/* Create an Xtensa ELF linker hash table.  */
645
 
646
static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
647
elf_xtensa_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
648
{
649
  struct elf_link_hash_entry *tlsbase;
650
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *ret;
651
  bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table);
652
 
653
  ret = bfd_malloc (amt);
654
  if (ret == NULL)
655
    return NULL;
656
 
657
  if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
658
                                      elf_xtensa_link_hash_newfunc,
659
                                      sizeof (struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry)))
660
    {
661
      free (ret);
662
      return NULL;
663
    }
664
 
665
  ret->sgot = NULL;
666
  ret->sgotplt = NULL;
667
  ret->srelgot = NULL;
668
  ret->splt = NULL;
669
  ret->srelplt = NULL;
670
  ret->sgotloc = NULL;
671
  ret->spltlittbl = NULL;
672
 
673
  ret->plt_reloc_count = 0;
674
 
675
  /* Create a hash entry for "_TLS_MODULE_BASE_" to speed up checking
676
     for it later.  */
677
  tlsbase = elf_link_hash_lookup (&ret->elf, "_TLS_MODULE_BASE_",
678
                                  TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
679
  tlsbase->root.type = bfd_link_hash_new;
680
  tlsbase->root.u.undef.abfd = NULL;
681
  tlsbase->non_elf = 0;
682
  ret->tlsbase = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (tlsbase);
683
  ret->tlsbase->tls_type = GOT_UNKNOWN;
684
 
685
  return &ret->elf.root;
686
}
687
 
688
/* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry.  */
689
 
690
static void
691
elf_xtensa_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
692
                                 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
693
                                 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
694
{
695
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
696
 
697
  edir = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (dir);
698
  eind = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (ind);
699
 
700
  if (ind->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
701
    {
702
      edir->tlsfunc_refcount += eind->tlsfunc_refcount;
703
      eind->tlsfunc_refcount = 0;
704
 
705
      if (dir->got.refcount <= 0)
706
        {
707
          edir->tls_type = eind->tls_type;
708
          eind->tls_type = GOT_UNKNOWN;
709
        }
710
    }
711
 
712
  _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (info, dir, ind);
713
}
714
 
715
static inline bfd_boolean
716
elf_xtensa_dynamic_symbol_p (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
717
                             struct bfd_link_info *info)
718
{
719
  /* Check if we should do dynamic things to this symbol.  The
720
     "ignore_protected" argument need not be set, because Xtensa code
721
     does not require special handling of STV_PROTECTED to make function
722
     pointer comparisons work properly.  The PLT addresses are never
723
     used for function pointers.  */
724
 
725
  return _bfd_elf_dynamic_symbol_p (h, info, 0);
726
}
727
 
728
 
729
static int
730
property_table_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
731
{
732
  const property_table_entry *a = (const property_table_entry *) ap;
733
  const property_table_entry *b = (const property_table_entry *) bp;
734
 
735
  if (a->address == b->address)
736
    {
737
      if (a->size != b->size)
738
        return (a->size - b->size);
739
 
740
      if ((a->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN) != (b->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN))
741
        return ((b->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN)
742
                - (a->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN));
743
 
744
      if ((a->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN)
745
          && (GET_XTENSA_PROP_ALIGNMENT (a->flags)
746
              != GET_XTENSA_PROP_ALIGNMENT (b->flags)))
747
        return (GET_XTENSA_PROP_ALIGNMENT (a->flags)
748
                - GET_XTENSA_PROP_ALIGNMENT (b->flags));
749
 
750
      if ((a->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE)
751
          != (b->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE))
752
        return ((b->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE)
753
                - (a->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE));
754
 
755
      return (a->flags - b->flags);
756
    }
757
 
758
  return (a->address - b->address);
759
}
760
 
761
 
762
static int
763
property_table_matches (const void *ap, const void *bp)
764
{
765
  const property_table_entry *a = (const property_table_entry *) ap;
766
  const property_table_entry *b = (const property_table_entry *) bp;
767
 
768
  /* Check if one entry overlaps with the other.  */
769
  if ((b->address >= a->address && b->address < (a->address + a->size))
770
      || (a->address >= b->address && a->address < (b->address + b->size)))
771
    return 0;
772
 
773
  return (a->address - b->address);
774
}
775
 
776
 
777
/* Get the literal table or property table entries for the given
778
   section.  Sets TABLE_P and returns the number of entries.  On
779
   error, returns a negative value.  */
780
 
781
static int
782
xtensa_read_table_entries (bfd *abfd,
783
                           asection *section,
784
                           property_table_entry **table_p,
785
                           const char *sec_name,
786
                           bfd_boolean output_addr)
787
{
788
  asection *table_section;
789
  bfd_size_type table_size = 0;
790
  bfd_byte *table_data;
791
  property_table_entry *blocks;
792
  int blk, block_count;
793
  bfd_size_type num_records;
794
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs, *irel, *rel_end;
795
  bfd_vma section_addr, off;
796
  flagword predef_flags;
797
  bfd_size_type table_entry_size, section_limit;
798
 
799
  if (!section
800
      || !(section->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
801
      || (section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
802
    {
803
      *table_p = NULL;
804
      return 0;
805
    }
806
 
807
  table_section = xtensa_get_property_section (section, sec_name);
808
  if (table_section)
809
    table_size = table_section->size;
810
 
811
  if (table_size == 0)
812
    {
813
      *table_p = NULL;
814
      return 0;
815
    }
816
 
817
  predef_flags = xtensa_get_property_predef_flags (table_section);
818
  table_entry_size = 12;
819
  if (predef_flags)
820
    table_entry_size -= 4;
821
 
822
  num_records = table_size / table_entry_size;
823
  table_data = retrieve_contents (abfd, table_section, TRUE);
824
  blocks = (property_table_entry *)
825
    bfd_malloc (num_records * sizeof (property_table_entry));
826
  block_count = 0;
827
 
828
  if (output_addr)
829
    section_addr = section->output_section->vma + section->output_offset;
830
  else
831
    section_addr = section->vma;
832
 
833
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, table_section, TRUE);
834
  if (internal_relocs && !table_section->reloc_done)
835
    {
836
      qsort (internal_relocs, table_section->reloc_count,
837
             sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela), internal_reloc_compare);
838
      irel = internal_relocs;
839
    }
840
  else
841
    irel = NULL;
842
 
843
  section_limit = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, section);
844
  rel_end = internal_relocs + table_section->reloc_count;
845
 
846
  for (off = 0; off < table_size; off += table_entry_size)
847
    {
848
      bfd_vma address = bfd_get_32 (abfd, table_data + off);
849
 
850
      /* Skip any relocations before the current offset.  This should help
851
         avoid confusion caused by unexpected relocations for the preceding
852
         table entry.  */
853
      while (irel &&
854
             (irel->r_offset < off
855
              || (irel->r_offset == off
856
                  && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) == R_XTENSA_NONE)))
857
        {
858
          irel += 1;
859
          if (irel >= rel_end)
860
            irel = 0;
861
        }
862
 
863
      if (irel && irel->r_offset == off)
864
        {
865
          bfd_vma sym_off;
866
          unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
867
          BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) == R_XTENSA_32);
868
 
869
          if (get_elf_r_symndx_section (abfd, r_symndx) != section)
870
            continue;
871
 
872
          sym_off = get_elf_r_symndx_offset (abfd, r_symndx);
873
          BFD_ASSERT (sym_off == 0);
874
          address += (section_addr + sym_off + irel->r_addend);
875
        }
876
      else
877
        {
878
          if (address < section_addr
879
              || address >= section_addr + section_limit)
880
            continue;
881
        }
882
 
883
      blocks[block_count].address = address;
884
      blocks[block_count].size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, table_data + off + 4);
885
      if (predef_flags)
886
        blocks[block_count].flags = predef_flags;
887
      else
888
        blocks[block_count].flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, table_data + off + 8);
889
      block_count++;
890
    }
891
 
892
  release_contents (table_section, table_data);
893
  release_internal_relocs (table_section, internal_relocs);
894
 
895
  if (block_count > 0)
896
    {
897
      /* Now sort them into address order for easy reference.  */
898
      qsort (blocks, block_count, sizeof (property_table_entry),
899
             property_table_compare);
900
 
901
      /* Check that the table contents are valid.  Problems may occur,
902
         for example, if an unrelocated object file is stripped.  */
903
      for (blk = 1; blk < block_count; blk++)
904
        {
905
          /* The only circumstance where two entries may legitimately
906
             have the same address is when one of them is a zero-size
907
             placeholder to mark a place where fill can be inserted.
908
             The zero-size entry should come first.  */
909
          if (blocks[blk - 1].address == blocks[blk].address &&
910
              blocks[blk - 1].size != 0)
911
            {
912
              (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B(%A): invalid property table"),
913
                                     abfd, section);
914
              bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
915
              free (blocks);
916
              return -1;
917
            }
918
        }
919
    }
920
 
921
  *table_p = blocks;
922
  return block_count;
923
}
924
 
925
 
926
static property_table_entry *
927
elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (property_table_entry *property_table,
928
                                int property_table_size,
929
                                bfd_vma addr)
930
{
931
  property_table_entry entry;
932
  property_table_entry *rv;
933
 
934
  if (property_table_size == 0)
935
    return NULL;
936
 
937
  entry.address = addr;
938
  entry.size = 1;
939
  entry.flags = 0;
940
 
941
  rv = bsearch (&entry, property_table, property_table_size,
942
                sizeof (property_table_entry), property_table_matches);
943
  return rv;
944
}
945
 
946
 
947
static bfd_boolean
948
elf_xtensa_in_literal_pool (property_table_entry *lit_table,
949
                            int lit_table_size,
950
                            bfd_vma addr)
951
{
952
  if (elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (lit_table, lit_table_size, addr))
953
    return TRUE;
954
 
955
  return FALSE;
956
}
957
 
958
 
959
/* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
960
   calculate needed space in the dynamic reloc sections.  */
961
 
962
static bfd_boolean
963
elf_xtensa_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
964
                         struct bfd_link_info *info,
965
                         asection *sec,
966
                         const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
967
{
968
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
969
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
970
  struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
971
  const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
972
  const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
973
 
974
  if (info->relocatable || (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
975
    return TRUE;
976
 
977
  BFD_ASSERT (is_xtensa_elf (abfd));
978
 
979
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
980
  symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
981
  sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
982
 
983
  rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
984
  for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
985
    {
986
      unsigned int r_type;
987
      unsigned long r_symndx;
988
      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
989
      struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *eh;
990
      int tls_type, old_tls_type;
991
      bfd_boolean is_got = FALSE;
992
      bfd_boolean is_plt = FALSE;
993
      bfd_boolean is_tlsfunc = FALSE;
994
 
995
      r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
996
      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
997
 
998
      if (r_symndx >= NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr))
999
        {
1000
          (*_bfd_error_handler) (_("%B: bad symbol index: %d"),
1001
                                 abfd, r_symndx);
1002
          return FALSE;
1003
        }
1004
 
1005
      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
1006
        {
1007
          h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
1008
          while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
1009
                 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1010
            h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
1011
        }
1012
      eh = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h);
1013
 
1014
      switch (r_type)
1015
        {
1016
        case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN:
1017
          if (info->shared)
1018
            {
1019
              tls_type = GOT_TLS_GD;
1020
              is_got = TRUE;
1021
              is_tlsfunc = TRUE;
1022
            }
1023
          else
1024
            tls_type = GOT_TLS_IE;
1025
          break;
1026
 
1027
        case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG:
1028
          if (info->shared)
1029
            {
1030
              tls_type = GOT_TLS_GD;
1031
              is_got = TRUE;
1032
            }
1033
          else
1034
            {
1035
              tls_type = GOT_TLS_IE;
1036
              if (h && elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h) != htab->tlsbase)
1037
                is_got = TRUE;
1038
            }
1039
          break;
1040
 
1041
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF:
1042
          if (info->shared)
1043
            tls_type = GOT_TLS_GD;
1044
          else
1045
            tls_type = GOT_TLS_IE;
1046
          break;
1047
 
1048
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF:
1049
          tls_type = GOT_TLS_IE;
1050
          if (info->shared)
1051
            info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
1052
          if (info->shared || h)
1053
            is_got = TRUE;
1054
          break;
1055
 
1056
        case R_XTENSA_32:
1057
          tls_type = GOT_NORMAL;
1058
          is_got = TRUE;
1059
          break;
1060
 
1061
        case R_XTENSA_PLT:
1062
          tls_type = GOT_NORMAL;
1063
          is_plt = TRUE;
1064
          break;
1065
 
1066
        case R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT:
1067
          /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
1068
             Reconstruct it for later use during GC.  */
1069
          if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
1070
            return FALSE;
1071
          continue;
1072
 
1073
        case R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY:
1074
          /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
1075
             used.  Record for later use during GC.  */
1076
          BFD_ASSERT (h != NULL);
1077
          if (h != NULL
1078
              && !bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
1079
            return FALSE;
1080
          continue;
1081
 
1082
        default:
1083
          /* Nothing to do for any other relocations.  */
1084
          continue;
1085
        }
1086
 
1087
      if (h)
1088
        {
1089
          if (is_plt)
1090
            {
1091
              if (h->plt.refcount <= 0)
1092
                {
1093
                  h->needs_plt = 1;
1094
                  h->plt.refcount = 1;
1095
                }
1096
              else
1097
                h->plt.refcount += 1;
1098
 
1099
              /* Keep track of the total PLT relocation count even if we
1100
                 don't yet know whether the dynamic sections will be
1101
                 created.  */
1102
              htab->plt_reloc_count += 1;
1103
 
1104
              if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
1105
                {
1106
                  if (! add_extra_plt_sections (info, htab->plt_reloc_count))
1107
                    return FALSE;
1108
                }
1109
            }
1110
          else if (is_got)
1111
            {
1112
              if (h->got.refcount <= 0)
1113
                h->got.refcount = 1;
1114
              else
1115
                h->got.refcount += 1;
1116
            }
1117
 
1118
          if (is_tlsfunc)
1119
            eh->tlsfunc_refcount += 1;
1120
 
1121
          old_tls_type = eh->tls_type;
1122
        }
1123
      else
1124
        {
1125
          /* Allocate storage the first time.  */
1126
          if (elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) == NULL)
1127
            {
1128
              bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
1129
              void *mem;
1130
 
1131
              mem = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size * sizeof (bfd_signed_vma));
1132
              if (mem == NULL)
1133
                return FALSE;
1134
              elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = (bfd_signed_vma *) mem;
1135
 
1136
              mem = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
1137
              if (mem == NULL)
1138
                return FALSE;
1139
              elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type (abfd) = (char *) mem;
1140
 
1141
              mem = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size * sizeof (bfd_signed_vma));
1142
              if (mem == NULL)
1143
                return FALSE;
1144
              elf_xtensa_local_tlsfunc_refcounts (abfd)
1145
                = (bfd_signed_vma *) mem;
1146
            }
1147
 
1148
          /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol.  */
1149
          if (is_got || is_plt)
1150
            elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) [r_symndx] += 1;
1151
 
1152
          if (is_tlsfunc)
1153
            elf_xtensa_local_tlsfunc_refcounts (abfd) [r_symndx] += 1;
1154
 
1155
          old_tls_type = elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type (abfd) [r_symndx];
1156
        }
1157
 
1158
      if ((old_tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) && (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE))
1159
        tls_type |= old_tls_type;
1160
      /* If a TLS symbol is accessed using IE at least once,
1161
         there is no point to use a dynamic model for it.  */
1162
      else if (old_tls_type != tls_type && old_tls_type != GOT_UNKNOWN
1163
               && ((old_tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD) == 0
1164
                   || (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) == 0))
1165
        {
1166
          if ((old_tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) && (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD))
1167
            tls_type = old_tls_type;
1168
          else if ((old_tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD) && (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD))
1169
            tls_type |= old_tls_type;
1170
          else
1171
            {
1172
              (*_bfd_error_handler)
1173
                (_("%B: `%s' accessed both as normal and thread local symbol"),
1174
                 abfd,
1175
                 h ? h->root.root.string : "<local>");
1176
              return FALSE;
1177
            }
1178
        }
1179
 
1180
      if (old_tls_type != tls_type)
1181
        {
1182
          if (eh)
1183
            eh->tls_type = tls_type;
1184
          else
1185
            elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type (abfd) [r_symndx] = tls_type;
1186
        }
1187
    }
1188
 
1189
  return TRUE;
1190
}
1191
 
1192
 
1193
static void
1194
elf_xtensa_make_sym_local (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1195
                           struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1196
{
1197
  if (info->shared)
1198
    {
1199
      if (h->plt.refcount > 0)
1200
        {
1201
          /* For shared objects, there's no need for PLT entries for local
1202
             symbols (use RELATIVE relocs instead of JMP_SLOT relocs).  */
1203
          if (h->got.refcount < 0)
1204
            h->got.refcount = 0;
1205
          h->got.refcount += h->plt.refcount;
1206
          h->plt.refcount = 0;
1207
        }
1208
    }
1209
  else
1210
    {
1211
      /* Don't need any dynamic relocations at all.  */
1212
      h->plt.refcount = 0;
1213
      h->got.refcount = 0;
1214
    }
1215
}
1216
 
1217
 
1218
static void
1219
elf_xtensa_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1220
                        struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1221
                        bfd_boolean force_local)
1222
{
1223
  /* For a shared link, move the plt refcount to the got refcount to leave
1224
     space for RELATIVE relocs.  */
1225
  elf_xtensa_make_sym_local (info, h);
1226
 
1227
  _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, h, force_local);
1228
}
1229
 
1230
 
1231
/* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
1232
   relocation.  */
1233
 
1234
static asection *
1235
elf_xtensa_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
1236
                         struct bfd_link_info *info,
1237
                         Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
1238
                         struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1239
                         Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
1240
{
1241
  /* Property sections are marked "KEEP" in the linker scripts, but they
1242
     should not cause other sections to be marked.  (This approach relies
1243
     on elf_xtensa_discard_info to remove property table entries that
1244
     describe discarded sections.  Alternatively, it might be more
1245
     efficient to avoid using "KEEP" in the linker scripts and instead use
1246
     the gc_mark_extra_sections hook to mark only the property sections
1247
     that describe marked sections.  That alternative does not work well
1248
     with the current property table sections, which do not correspond
1249
     one-to-one with the sections they describe, but that should be fixed
1250
     someday.) */
1251
  if (xtensa_is_property_section (sec))
1252
    return NULL;
1253
 
1254
  if (h != NULL)
1255
    switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
1256
      {
1257
      case R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT:
1258
      case R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY:
1259
        return NULL;
1260
      }
1261
 
1262
  return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
1263
}
1264
 
1265
 
1266
/* Update the GOT & PLT entry reference counts
1267
   for the section being removed.  */
1268
 
1269
static bfd_boolean
1270
elf_xtensa_gc_sweep_hook (bfd *abfd,
1271
                          struct bfd_link_info *info,
1272
                          asection *sec,
1273
                          const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
1274
{
1275
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
1276
  struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
1277
  const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, *relend;
1278
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1279
 
1280
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1281
 
1282
  if (info->relocatable)
1283
    return TRUE;
1284
 
1285
  if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
1286
    return TRUE;
1287
 
1288
  symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
1289
  sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
1290
 
1291
  relend = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
1292
  for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel++)
1293
    {
1294
      unsigned long r_symndx;
1295
      unsigned int r_type;
1296
      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
1297
      struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *eh;
1298
      bfd_boolean is_got = FALSE;
1299
      bfd_boolean is_plt = FALSE;
1300
      bfd_boolean is_tlsfunc = FALSE;
1301
 
1302
      r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
1303
      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
1304
        {
1305
          h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
1306
          while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
1307
                 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1308
            h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
1309
        }
1310
      eh = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h);
1311
 
1312
      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
1313
      switch (r_type)
1314
        {
1315
        case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN:
1316
          if (info->shared)
1317
            {
1318
              is_got = TRUE;
1319
              is_tlsfunc = TRUE;
1320
            }
1321
          break;
1322
 
1323
        case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG:
1324
          if (info->shared)
1325
            is_got = TRUE;
1326
          else
1327
            {
1328
              if (h && elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h) != htab->tlsbase)
1329
                is_got = TRUE;
1330
            }
1331
          break;
1332
 
1333
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF:
1334
          if (info->shared || h)
1335
            is_got = TRUE;
1336
          break;
1337
 
1338
        case R_XTENSA_32:
1339
          is_got = TRUE;
1340
          break;
1341
 
1342
        case R_XTENSA_PLT:
1343
          is_plt = TRUE;
1344
          break;
1345
 
1346
        default:
1347
          continue;
1348
        }
1349
 
1350
      if (h)
1351
        {
1352
          if (is_plt)
1353
            {
1354
              if (h->plt.refcount > 0)
1355
                h->plt.refcount--;
1356
            }
1357
          else if (is_got)
1358
            {
1359
              if (h->got.refcount > 0)
1360
                h->got.refcount--;
1361
            }
1362
          if (is_tlsfunc)
1363
            {
1364
              if (eh->tlsfunc_refcount > 0)
1365
                eh->tlsfunc_refcount--;
1366
            }
1367
        }
1368
      else
1369
        {
1370
          if (is_got || is_plt)
1371
            {
1372
              bfd_signed_vma *got_refcount
1373
                = &elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) [r_symndx];
1374
              if (*got_refcount > 0)
1375
                *got_refcount -= 1;
1376
            }
1377
          if (is_tlsfunc)
1378
            {
1379
              bfd_signed_vma *tlsfunc_refcount
1380
                = &elf_xtensa_local_tlsfunc_refcounts (abfd) [r_symndx];
1381
              if (*tlsfunc_refcount > 0)
1382
                *tlsfunc_refcount -= 1;
1383
            }
1384
        }
1385
    }
1386
 
1387
  return TRUE;
1388
}
1389
 
1390
 
1391
/* Create all the dynamic sections.  */
1392
 
1393
static bfd_boolean
1394
elf_xtensa_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *dynobj, struct bfd_link_info *info)
1395
{
1396
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1397
  flagword flags, noalloc_flags;
1398
 
1399
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1400
 
1401
  /* First do all the standard stuff.  */
1402
  if (! _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (dynobj, info))
1403
    return FALSE;
1404
  htab->splt = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".plt");
1405
  htab->srelplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rela.plt");
1406
  htab->sgot = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".got");
1407
  htab->sgotplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".got.plt");
1408
  htab->srelgot = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rela.got");
1409
 
1410
  /* Create any extra PLT sections in case check_relocs has already
1411
     been called on all the non-dynamic input files.  */
1412
  if (! add_extra_plt_sections (info, htab->plt_reloc_count))
1413
    return FALSE;
1414
 
1415
  noalloc_flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
1416
                   | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
1417
  flags = noalloc_flags | SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD;
1418
 
1419
  /* Mark the ".got.plt" section READONLY.  */
1420
  if (htab->sgotplt == NULL
1421
      || ! bfd_set_section_flags (dynobj, htab->sgotplt, flags))
1422
    return FALSE;
1423
 
1424
  /* Create ".got.loc" (literal tables for use by dynamic linker).  */
1425
  htab->sgotloc = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, ".got.loc", flags);
1426
  if (htab->sgotloc == NULL
1427
      || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->sgotloc, 2))
1428
    return FALSE;
1429
 
1430
  /* Create ".xt.lit.plt" (literal table for ".got.plt*").  */
1431
  htab->spltlittbl = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, ".xt.lit.plt",
1432
                                                  noalloc_flags);
1433
  if (htab->spltlittbl == NULL
1434
      || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->spltlittbl, 2))
1435
    return FALSE;
1436
 
1437
  return TRUE;
1438
}
1439
 
1440
 
1441
static bfd_boolean
1442
add_extra_plt_sections (struct bfd_link_info *info, int count)
1443
{
1444
  bfd *dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
1445
  int chunk;
1446
 
1447
  /* Iterate over all chunks except 0 which uses the standard ".plt" and
1448
     ".got.plt" sections.  */
1449
  for (chunk = count / PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK; chunk > 0; chunk--)
1450
    {
1451
      char *sname;
1452
      flagword flags;
1453
      asection *s;
1454
 
1455
      /* Stop when we find a section has already been created.  */
1456
      if (elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (info, chunk))
1457
        break;
1458
 
1459
      flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
1460
               | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
1461
 
1462
      sname = (char *) bfd_malloc (10);
1463
      sprintf (sname, ".plt.%u", chunk);
1464
      s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, sname, flags | SEC_CODE);
1465
      if (s == NULL
1466
          || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, s, 2))
1467
        return FALSE;
1468
 
1469
      sname = (char *) bfd_malloc (14);
1470
      sprintf (sname, ".got.plt.%u", chunk);
1471
      s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, sname, flags);
1472
      if (s == NULL
1473
          || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, s, 2))
1474
        return FALSE;
1475
    }
1476
 
1477
  return TRUE;
1478
}
1479
 
1480
 
1481
/* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
1482
   regular object.  The current definition is in some section of the
1483
   dynamic object, but we're not including those sections.  We have to
1484
   change the definition to something the rest of the link can
1485
   understand.  */
1486
 
1487
static bfd_boolean
1488
elf_xtensa_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1489
                                  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1490
{
1491
  /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
1492
     processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
1493
     real definition first, and we can just use the same value.  */
1494
  if (h->u.weakdef)
1495
    {
1496
      BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1497
                  || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
1498
      h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
1499
      h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
1500
      return TRUE;
1501
    }
1502
 
1503
  /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object.  The
1504
     reference must go through the GOT, so there's no need for COPY relocs,
1505
     .dynbss, etc.  */
1506
 
1507
  return TRUE;
1508
}
1509
 
1510
 
1511
static bfd_boolean
1512
elf_xtensa_allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *arg)
1513
{
1514
  struct bfd_link_info *info;
1515
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1516
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_entry *eh = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h);
1517
 
1518
  if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
1519
    return TRUE;
1520
 
1521
  if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1522
    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
1523
 
1524
  info = (struct bfd_link_info *) arg;
1525
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1526
 
1527
  /* If we saw any use of an IE model for this symbol, we can then optimize
1528
     away GOT entries for any TLSDESC_FN relocs.  */
1529
  if ((eh->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) != 0)
1530
    {
1531
      BFD_ASSERT (h->got.refcount >= eh->tlsfunc_refcount);
1532
      h->got.refcount -= eh->tlsfunc_refcount;
1533
    }
1534
 
1535
  if (! elf_xtensa_dynamic_symbol_p (h, info))
1536
    elf_xtensa_make_sym_local (info, h);
1537
 
1538
  if (h->plt.refcount > 0)
1539
    htab->srelplt->size += (h->plt.refcount * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
1540
 
1541
  if (h->got.refcount > 0)
1542
    htab->srelgot->size += (h->got.refcount * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
1543
 
1544
  return TRUE;
1545
}
1546
 
1547
 
1548
static void
1549
elf_xtensa_allocate_local_got_size (struct bfd_link_info *info)
1550
{
1551
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1552
  bfd *i;
1553
 
1554
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1555
 
1556
  for (i = info->input_bfds; i; i = i->link_next)
1557
    {
1558
      bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
1559
      bfd_size_type j, cnt;
1560
      Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
1561
 
1562
      local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (i);
1563
      if (!local_got_refcounts)
1564
        continue;
1565
 
1566
      symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (i)->symtab_hdr;
1567
      cnt = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
1568
 
1569
      for (j = 0; j < cnt; ++j)
1570
        {
1571
          /* If we saw any use of an IE model for this symbol, we can
1572
             then optimize away GOT entries for any TLSDESC_FN relocs.  */
1573
          if ((elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type (i) [j] & GOT_TLS_IE) != 0)
1574
            {
1575
              bfd_signed_vma *tlsfunc_refcount
1576
                = &elf_xtensa_local_tlsfunc_refcounts (i) [j];
1577
              BFD_ASSERT (local_got_refcounts[j] >= *tlsfunc_refcount);
1578
              local_got_refcounts[j] -= *tlsfunc_refcount;
1579
            }
1580
 
1581
          if (local_got_refcounts[j] > 0)
1582
            htab->srelgot->size += (local_got_refcounts[j]
1583
                                    * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
1584
        }
1585
    }
1586
}
1587
 
1588
 
1589
/* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections.  */
1590
 
1591
static bfd_boolean
1592
elf_xtensa_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1593
                                  struct bfd_link_info *info)
1594
{
1595
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1596
  bfd *dynobj, *abfd;
1597
  asection *s, *srelplt, *splt, *sgotplt, *srelgot, *spltlittbl, *sgotloc;
1598
  bfd_boolean relplt, relgot;
1599
  int plt_entries, plt_chunks, chunk;
1600
 
1601
  plt_entries = 0;
1602
  plt_chunks = 0;
1603
 
1604
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1605
  dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
1606
  if (dynobj == NULL)
1607
    abort ();
1608
  srelgot = htab->srelgot;
1609
  srelplt = htab->srelplt;
1610
 
1611
  if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
1612
    {
1613
      BFD_ASSERT (htab->srelgot != NULL
1614
                  && htab->srelplt != NULL
1615
                  && htab->sgot != NULL
1616
                  && htab->spltlittbl != NULL
1617
                  && htab->sgotloc != NULL);
1618
 
1619
      /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter.  */
1620
      if (info->executable)
1621
        {
1622
          s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".interp");
1623
          if (s == NULL)
1624
            abort ();
1625
          s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
1626
          s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
1627
        }
1628
 
1629
      /* Allocate room for one word in ".got".  */
1630
      htab->sgot->size = 4;
1631
 
1632
      /* Allocate space in ".rela.got" for literals that reference global
1633
         symbols and space in ".rela.plt" for literals that have PLT
1634
         entries.  */
1635
      elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
1636
                              elf_xtensa_allocate_dynrelocs,
1637
                              (void *) info);
1638
 
1639
      /* If we are generating a shared object, we also need space in
1640
         ".rela.got" for R_XTENSA_RELATIVE relocs for literals that
1641
         reference local symbols.  */
1642
      if (info->shared)
1643
        elf_xtensa_allocate_local_got_size (info);
1644
 
1645
      /* Allocate space in ".plt" to match the size of ".rela.plt".  For
1646
         each PLT entry, we need the PLT code plus a 4-byte literal.
1647
         For each chunk of ".plt", we also need two more 4-byte
1648
         literals, two corresponding entries in ".rela.got", and an
1649
         8-byte entry in ".xt.lit.plt".  */
1650
      spltlittbl = htab->spltlittbl;
1651
      plt_entries = srelplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1652
      plt_chunks =
1653
        (plt_entries + PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK - 1) / PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
1654
 
1655
      /* Iterate over all the PLT chunks, including any extra sections
1656
         created earlier because the initial count of PLT relocations
1657
         was an overestimate.  */
1658
      for (chunk = 0;
1659
           (splt = elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (info, chunk)) != NULL;
1660
           chunk++)
1661
        {
1662
          int chunk_entries;
1663
 
1664
          sgotplt = elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (info, chunk);
1665
          BFD_ASSERT (sgotplt != NULL);
1666
 
1667
          if (chunk < plt_chunks - 1)
1668
            chunk_entries = PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
1669
          else if (chunk == plt_chunks - 1)
1670
            chunk_entries = plt_entries - (chunk * PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK);
1671
          else
1672
            chunk_entries = 0;
1673
 
1674
          if (chunk_entries != 0)
1675
            {
1676
              sgotplt->size = 4 * (chunk_entries + 2);
1677
              splt->size = PLT_ENTRY_SIZE * chunk_entries;
1678
              srelgot->size += 2 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1679
              spltlittbl->size += 8;
1680
            }
1681
          else
1682
            {
1683
              sgotplt->size = 0;
1684
              splt->size = 0;
1685
            }
1686
        }
1687
 
1688
      /* Allocate space in ".got.loc" to match the total size of all the
1689
         literal tables.  */
1690
      sgotloc = htab->sgotloc;
1691
      sgotloc->size = spltlittbl->size;
1692
      for (abfd = info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link_next)
1693
        {
1694
          if (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC)
1695
            continue;
1696
          for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1697
            {
1698
              if (! elf_discarded_section (s)
1699
                  && xtensa_is_littable_section (s)
1700
                  && s != spltlittbl)
1701
                sgotloc->size += s->size;
1702
            }
1703
        }
1704
    }
1705
 
1706
  /* Allocate memory for dynamic sections.  */
1707
  relplt = FALSE;
1708
  relgot = FALSE;
1709
  for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1710
    {
1711
      const char *name;
1712
 
1713
      if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
1714
        continue;
1715
 
1716
      /* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none
1717
         of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files.  */
1718
      name = bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s);
1719
 
1720
      if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rela"))
1721
        {
1722
          if (s->size != 0)
1723
            {
1724
              if (strcmp (name, ".rela.plt") == 0)
1725
                relplt = TRUE;
1726
              else if (strcmp (name, ".rela.got") == 0)
1727
                relgot = TRUE;
1728
 
1729
              /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
1730
                 to copy relocs into the output file.  */
1731
              s->reloc_count = 0;
1732
            }
1733
        }
1734
      else if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".plt.")
1735
               && ! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".got.plt.")
1736
               && strcmp (name, ".got") != 0
1737
               && strcmp (name, ".plt") != 0
1738
               && strcmp (name, ".got.plt") != 0
1739
               && strcmp (name, ".xt.lit.plt") != 0
1740
               && strcmp (name, ".got.loc") != 0)
1741
        {
1742
          /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space.  */
1743
          continue;
1744
        }
1745
 
1746
      if (s->size == 0)
1747
        {
1748
          /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the output
1749
             file.  We must create the ".plt*" and ".got.plt*"
1750
             sections in create_dynamic_sections and/or check_relocs
1751
             based on a conservative estimate of the PLT relocation
1752
             count, because the sections must be created before the
1753
             linker maps input sections to output sections.  The
1754
             linker does that before size_dynamic_sections, where we
1755
             compute the exact size of the PLT, so there may be more
1756
             of these sections than are actually needed.  */
1757
          s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1758
        }
1759
      else if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0)
1760
        {
1761
          /* Allocate memory for the section contents.  */
1762
          s->contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
1763
          if (s->contents == NULL)
1764
            return FALSE;
1765
        }
1766
    }
1767
 
1768
  if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
1769
    {
1770
      /* Add the special XTENSA_RTLD relocations now.  The offsets won't be
1771
         known until finish_dynamic_sections, but we need to get the relocs
1772
         in place before they are sorted.  */
1773
      for (chunk = 0; chunk < plt_chunks; chunk++)
1774
        {
1775
          Elf_Internal_Rela irela;
1776
          bfd_byte *loc;
1777
 
1778
          irela.r_offset = 0;
1779
          irela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_RTLD);
1780
          irela.r_addend = 0;
1781
 
1782
          loc = (srelgot->contents
1783
                 + srelgot->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
1784
          bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &irela, loc);
1785
          bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &irela,
1786
                                     loc + sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
1787
          srelgot->reloc_count += 2;
1788
        }
1789
 
1790
      /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section.  We fill in the
1791
         values later, in elf_xtensa_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
1792
         must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
1793
         the .dynamic section.  The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
1794
         dynamic linker and used by the debugger.  */
1795
#define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
1796
  _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
1797
 
1798
      if (info->executable)
1799
        {
1800
          if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
1801
            return FALSE;
1802
        }
1803
 
1804
      if (relplt)
1805
        {
1806
          if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
1807
              || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
1808
              || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0))
1809
            return FALSE;
1810
        }
1811
 
1812
      if (relgot)
1813
        {
1814
          if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
1815
              || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
1816
              || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)))
1817
            return FALSE;
1818
        }
1819
 
1820
      if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
1821
          || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_XTENSA_GOT_LOC_OFF, 0)
1822
          || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_XTENSA_GOT_LOC_SZ, 0))
1823
        return FALSE;
1824
    }
1825
#undef add_dynamic_entry
1826
 
1827
  return TRUE;
1828
}
1829
 
1830
static bfd_boolean
1831
elf_xtensa_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
1832
                                 struct bfd_link_info *info)
1833
{
1834
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
1835
  asection *tls_sec;
1836
 
1837
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
1838
  tls_sec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
1839
 
1840
  if (tls_sec && (htab->tlsbase->tls_type & GOT_TLS_ANY) != 0)
1841
    {
1842
      struct elf_link_hash_entry *tlsbase = &htab->tlsbase->elf;
1843
      struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh = &tlsbase->root;
1844
      const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
1845
 
1846
      tlsbase->type = STT_TLS;
1847
      if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
1848
            (info, output_bfd, "_TLS_MODULE_BASE_", BSF_LOCAL,
1849
             tls_sec, 0, NULL, FALSE,
1850
             bed->collect, &bh)))
1851
        return FALSE;
1852
      tlsbase->def_regular = 1;
1853
      tlsbase->other = STV_HIDDEN;
1854
      (*bed->elf_backend_hide_symbol) (info, tlsbase, TRUE);
1855
    }
1856
 
1857
  return TRUE;
1858
}
1859
 
1860
 
1861
/* Return the base VMA address which should be subtracted from real addresses
1862
   when resolving @dtpoff relocation.
1863
   This is PT_TLS segment p_vaddr.  */
1864
 
1865
static bfd_vma
1866
dtpoff_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
1867
{
1868
  /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already.  */
1869
  if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
1870
    return 0;
1871
  return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma;
1872
}
1873
 
1874
/* Return the relocation value for @tpoff relocation
1875
   if STT_TLS virtual address is ADDRESS.  */
1876
 
1877
static bfd_vma
1878
tpoff (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd_vma address)
1879
{
1880
  struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
1881
  bfd_vma base;
1882
 
1883
  /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already.  */
1884
  if (htab->tls_sec == NULL)
1885
    return 0;
1886
  base = align_power ((bfd_vma) TCB_SIZE, htab->tls_sec->alignment_power);
1887
  return address - htab->tls_sec->vma + base;
1888
}
1889
 
1890
/* Perform the specified relocation.  The instruction at (contents + address)
1891
   is modified to set one operand to represent the value in "relocation".  The
1892
   operand position is determined by the relocation type recorded in the
1893
   howto.  */
1894
 
1895
#define CALL_SEGMENT_BITS (30)
1896
#define CALL_SEGMENT_SIZE (1 << CALL_SEGMENT_BITS)
1897
 
1898
static bfd_reloc_status_type
1899
elf_xtensa_do_reloc (reloc_howto_type *howto,
1900
                     bfd *abfd,
1901
                     asection *input_section,
1902
                     bfd_vma relocation,
1903
                     bfd_byte *contents,
1904
                     bfd_vma address,
1905
                     bfd_boolean is_weak_undef,
1906
                     char **error_message)
1907
{
1908
  xtensa_format fmt;
1909
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
1910
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
1911
  static xtensa_insnbuf ibuff = NULL;
1912
  static xtensa_insnbuf sbuff = NULL;
1913
  bfd_vma self_address;
1914
  bfd_size_type input_size;
1915
  int opnd, slot;
1916
  uint32 newval;
1917
 
1918
  if (!ibuff)
1919
    {
1920
      ibuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
1921
      sbuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
1922
    }
1923
 
1924
  input_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section);
1925
 
1926
  /* Calculate the PC address for this instruction.  */
1927
  self_address = (input_section->output_section->vma
1928
                  + input_section->output_offset
1929
                  + address);
1930
 
1931
  switch (howto->type)
1932
    {
1933
    case R_XTENSA_NONE:
1934
    case R_XTENSA_DIFF8:
1935
    case R_XTENSA_DIFF16:
1936
    case R_XTENSA_DIFF32:
1937
    case R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
1938
    case R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
1939
    case R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
1940
      return bfd_reloc_ok;
1941
 
1942
    case R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND:
1943
      if (!is_weak_undef)
1944
        {
1945
          /* Check for windowed CALL across a 1GB boundary.  */
1946
          xtensa_opcode opcode =
1947
            get_expanded_call_opcode (contents + address,
1948
                                      input_size - address, 0);
1949
          if (is_windowed_call_opcode (opcode))
1950
            {
1951
              if ((self_address >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS)
1952
                  != (relocation >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS))
1953
                {
1954
                  *error_message = "windowed longcall crosses 1GB boundary; "
1955
                    "return may fail";
1956
                  return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
1957
                }
1958
            }
1959
        }
1960
      return bfd_reloc_ok;
1961
 
1962
    case R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY:
1963
      {
1964
        /* Convert the L32R/CALLX to CALL.  */
1965
        bfd_reloc_status_type retval =
1966
          elf_xtensa_do_asm_simplify (contents, address, input_size,
1967
                                      error_message);
1968
        if (retval != bfd_reloc_ok)
1969
          return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
1970
 
1971
        /* The CALL needs to be relocated.  Continue below for that part.  */
1972
        address += 3;
1973
        self_address += 3;
1974
        howto = &elf_howto_table[(unsigned) R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP ];
1975
      }
1976
      break;
1977
 
1978
    case R_XTENSA_32:
1979
      {
1980
        bfd_vma x;
1981
        x = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + address);
1982
        x = x + relocation;
1983
        bfd_put_32 (abfd, x, contents + address);
1984
      }
1985
      return bfd_reloc_ok;
1986
 
1987
    case R_XTENSA_32_PCREL:
1988
      bfd_put_32 (abfd, relocation - self_address, contents + address);
1989
      return bfd_reloc_ok;
1990
 
1991
    case R_XTENSA_PLT:
1992
    case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN:
1993
    case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG:
1994
    case R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF:
1995
    case R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF:
1996
      bfd_put_32 (abfd, relocation, contents + address);
1997
      return bfd_reloc_ok;
1998
    }
1999
 
2000
  /* Only instruction slot-specific relocations handled below.... */
2001
  slot = get_relocation_slot (howto->type);
2002
  if (slot == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2003
    {
2004
      *error_message = "unexpected relocation";
2005
      return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2006
    }
2007
 
2008
  /* Read the instruction into a buffer and decode the opcode.  */
2009
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, ibuff, contents + address,
2010
                             input_size - address);
2011
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, ibuff);
2012
  if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2013
    {
2014
      *error_message = "cannot decode instruction format";
2015
      return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2016
    }
2017
 
2018
  xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, slot, ibuff, sbuff);
2019
 
2020
  opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, slot, sbuff);
2021
  if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2022
    {
2023
      *error_message = "cannot decode instruction opcode";
2024
      return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2025
    }
2026
 
2027
  /* Check for opcode-specific "alternate" relocations.  */
2028
  if (is_alt_relocation (howto->type))
2029
    {
2030
      if (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ())
2031
        {
2032
          /* Handle the special-case of non-PC-relative L32R instructions.  */
2033
          bfd *output_bfd = input_section->output_section->owner;
2034
          asection *lit4_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".lit4");
2035
          if (!lit4_sec)
2036
            {
2037
              *error_message = "relocation references missing .lit4 section";
2038
              return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2039
            }
2040
          self_address = ((lit4_sec->vma & ~0xfff)
2041
                          + 0x40000 - 3); /* -3 to compensate for do_reloc */
2042
          newval = relocation;
2043
          opnd = 1;
2044
        }
2045
      else if (opcode == get_const16_opcode ())
2046
        {
2047
          /* ALT used for high 16 bits.  */
2048
          newval = relocation >> 16;
2049
          opnd = 1;
2050
        }
2051
      else
2052
        {
2053
          /* No other "alternate" relocations currently defined.  */
2054
          *error_message = "unexpected relocation";
2055
          return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2056
        }
2057
    }
2058
  else /* Not an "alternate" relocation.... */
2059
    {
2060
      if (opcode == get_const16_opcode ())
2061
        {
2062
          newval = relocation & 0xffff;
2063
          opnd = 1;
2064
        }
2065
      else
2066
        {
2067
          /* ...normal PC-relative relocation.... */
2068
 
2069
          /* Determine which operand is being relocated.  */
2070
          opnd = get_relocation_opnd (opcode, howto->type);
2071
          if (opnd == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2072
            {
2073
              *error_message = "unexpected relocation";
2074
              return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2075
            }
2076
 
2077
          if (!howto->pc_relative)
2078
            {
2079
              *error_message = "expected PC-relative relocation";
2080
              return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2081
            }
2082
 
2083
          newval = relocation;
2084
        }
2085
    }
2086
 
2087
  /* Apply the relocation.  */
2088
  if (xtensa_operand_do_reloc (isa, opcode, opnd, &newval, self_address)
2089
      || xtensa_operand_encode (isa, opcode, opnd, &newval)
2090
      || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, opcode, opnd, fmt, slot,
2091
                                   sbuff, newval))
2092
    {
2093
      const char *opname = xtensa_opcode_name (isa, opcode);
2094
      const char *msg;
2095
 
2096
      msg = "cannot encode";
2097
      if (is_direct_call_opcode (opcode))
2098
        {
2099
          if ((relocation & 0x3) != 0)
2100
            msg = "misaligned call target";
2101
          else
2102
            msg = "call target out of range";
2103
        }
2104
      else if (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ())
2105
        {
2106
          if ((relocation & 0x3) != 0)
2107
            msg = "misaligned literal target";
2108
          else if (is_alt_relocation (howto->type))
2109
            msg = "literal target out of range (too many literals)";
2110
          else if (self_address > relocation)
2111
            msg = "literal target out of range (try using text-section-literals)";
2112
          else
2113
            msg = "literal placed after use";
2114
        }
2115
 
2116
      *error_message = vsprint_msg (opname, ": %s", strlen (msg) + 2, msg);
2117
      return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2118
    }
2119
 
2120
  /* Check for calls across 1GB boundaries.  */
2121
  if (is_direct_call_opcode (opcode)
2122
      && is_windowed_call_opcode (opcode))
2123
    {
2124
      if ((self_address >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS)
2125
          != (relocation >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS))
2126
        {
2127
          *error_message =
2128
            "windowed call crosses 1GB boundary; return may fail";
2129
          return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
2130
        }
2131
    }
2132
 
2133
  /* Write the modified instruction back out of the buffer.  */
2134
  xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, fmt, slot, ibuff, sbuff);
2135
  xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, ibuff, contents + address,
2136
                           input_size - address);
2137
  return bfd_reloc_ok;
2138
}
2139
 
2140
 
2141
static char *
2142
vsprint_msg (const char *origmsg, const char *fmt, int arglen, ...)
2143
{
2144
  /* To reduce the size of the memory leak,
2145
     we only use a single message buffer.  */
2146
  static bfd_size_type alloc_size = 0;
2147
  static char *message = NULL;
2148
  bfd_size_type orig_len, len = 0;
2149
  bfd_boolean is_append;
2150
 
2151
  VA_OPEN (ap, arglen);
2152
  VA_FIXEDARG (ap, const char *, origmsg);
2153
 
2154
  is_append = (origmsg == message);
2155
 
2156
  orig_len = strlen (origmsg);
2157
  len = orig_len + strlen (fmt) + arglen + 20;
2158
  if (len > alloc_size)
2159
    {
2160
      message = (char *) bfd_realloc_or_free (message, len);
2161
      alloc_size = len;
2162
    }
2163
  if (message != NULL)
2164
    {
2165
      if (!is_append)
2166
        memcpy (message, origmsg, orig_len);
2167
      vsprintf (message + orig_len, fmt, ap);
2168
    }
2169
  VA_CLOSE (ap);
2170
  return message;
2171
}
2172
 
2173
 
2174
/* This function is registered as the "special_function" in the
2175
   Xtensa howto for handling simplify operations.
2176
   bfd_perform_relocation / bfd_install_relocation use it to
2177
   perform (install) the specified relocation.  Since this replaces the code
2178
   in bfd_perform_relocation, it is basically an Xtensa-specific,
2179
   stripped-down version of bfd_perform_relocation.  */
2180
 
2181
static bfd_reloc_status_type
2182
bfd_elf_xtensa_reloc (bfd *abfd,
2183
                      arelent *reloc_entry,
2184
                      asymbol *symbol,
2185
                      void *data,
2186
                      asection *input_section,
2187
                      bfd *output_bfd,
2188
                      char **error_message)
2189
{
2190
  bfd_vma relocation;
2191
  bfd_reloc_status_type flag;
2192
  bfd_size_type octets = reloc_entry->address * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd);
2193
  bfd_vma output_base = 0;
2194
  reloc_howto_type *howto = reloc_entry->howto;
2195
  asection *reloc_target_output_section;
2196
  bfd_boolean is_weak_undef;
2197
 
2198
  if (!xtensa_default_isa)
2199
    xtensa_default_isa = xtensa_isa_init (0, 0);
2200
 
2201
  /* ELF relocs are against symbols.  If we are producing relocatable
2202
     output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, the resulting
2203
     reloc will also be against the same symbol.  In such a case, we
2204
     don't want to change anything about the way the reloc is handled,
2205
     since it will all be done at final link time.  This test is similar
2206
     to what bfd_elf_generic_reloc does except that it lets relocs with
2207
     howto->partial_inplace go through even if the addend is non-zero.
2208
     (The real problem is that partial_inplace is set for XTENSA_32
2209
     relocs to begin with, but that's a long story and there's little we
2210
     can do about it now....)  */
2211
 
2212
  if (output_bfd && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
2213
    {
2214
      reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2215
      return bfd_reloc_ok;
2216
    }
2217
 
2218
  /* Is the address of the relocation really within the section?  */
2219
  if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2220
    return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2221
 
2222
  /* Work out which section the relocation is targeted at and the
2223
     initial relocation command value.  */
2224
 
2225
  /* Get symbol value.  (Common symbols are special.)  */
2226
  if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
2227
    relocation = 0;
2228
  else
2229
    relocation = symbol->value;
2230
 
2231
  reloc_target_output_section = symbol->section->output_section;
2232
 
2233
  /* Convert input-section-relative symbol value to absolute.  */
2234
  if ((output_bfd && !howto->partial_inplace)
2235
      || reloc_target_output_section == NULL)
2236
    output_base = 0;
2237
  else
2238
    output_base = reloc_target_output_section->vma;
2239
 
2240
  relocation += output_base + symbol->section->output_offset;
2241
 
2242
  /* Add in supplied addend.  */
2243
  relocation += reloc_entry->addend;
2244
 
2245
  /* Here the variable relocation holds the final address of the
2246
     symbol we are relocating against, plus any addend.  */
2247
  if (output_bfd)
2248
    {
2249
      if (!howto->partial_inplace)
2250
        {
2251
          /* This is a partial relocation, and we want to apply the relocation
2252
             to the reloc entry rather than the raw data.  Everything except
2253
             relocations against section symbols has already been handled
2254
             above.  */
2255
 
2256
          BFD_ASSERT (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM);
2257
          reloc_entry->addend = relocation;
2258
          reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2259
          return bfd_reloc_ok;
2260
        }
2261
      else
2262
        {
2263
          reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2264
          reloc_entry->addend = 0;
2265
        }
2266
    }
2267
 
2268
  is_weak_undef = (bfd_is_und_section (symbol->section)
2269
                   && (symbol->flags & BSF_WEAK) != 0);
2270
  flag = elf_xtensa_do_reloc (howto, abfd, input_section, relocation,
2271
                              (bfd_byte *) data, (bfd_vma) octets,
2272
                              is_weak_undef, error_message);
2273
 
2274
  if (flag == bfd_reloc_dangerous)
2275
    {
2276
      /* Add the symbol name to the error message.  */
2277
      if (! *error_message)
2278
        *error_message = "";
2279
      *error_message = vsprint_msg (*error_message, ": (%s + 0x%lx)",
2280
                                    strlen (symbol->name) + 17,
2281
                                    symbol->name,
2282
                                    (unsigned long) reloc_entry->addend);
2283
    }
2284
 
2285
  return flag;
2286
}
2287
 
2288
 
2289
/* Set up an entry in the procedure linkage table.  */
2290
 
2291
static bfd_vma
2292
elf_xtensa_create_plt_entry (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2293
                             bfd *output_bfd,
2294
                             unsigned reloc_index)
2295
{
2296
  asection *splt, *sgotplt;
2297
  bfd_vma plt_base, got_base;
2298
  bfd_vma code_offset, lit_offset;
2299
  int chunk;
2300
 
2301
  chunk = reloc_index / PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
2302
  splt = elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (info, chunk);
2303
  sgotplt = elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (info, chunk);
2304
  BFD_ASSERT (splt != NULL && sgotplt != NULL);
2305
 
2306
  plt_base = splt->output_section->vma + splt->output_offset;
2307
  got_base = sgotplt->output_section->vma + sgotplt->output_offset;
2308
 
2309
  lit_offset = 8 + (reloc_index % PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK) * 4;
2310
  code_offset = (reloc_index % PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK) * PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
2311
 
2312
  /* Fill in the literal entry.  This is the offset of the dynamic
2313
     relocation entry.  */
2314
  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, reloc_index * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela),
2315
              sgotplt->contents + lit_offset);
2316
 
2317
  /* Fill in the entry in the procedure linkage table.  */
2318
  memcpy (splt->contents + code_offset,
2319
          (bfd_big_endian (output_bfd)
2320
           ? elf_xtensa_be_plt_entry
2321
           : elf_xtensa_le_plt_entry),
2322
          PLT_ENTRY_SIZE);
2323
  bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, l32r_offset (got_base + 0,
2324
                                       plt_base + code_offset + 3),
2325
              splt->contents + code_offset + 4);
2326
  bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, l32r_offset (got_base + 4,
2327
                                       plt_base + code_offset + 6),
2328
              splt->contents + code_offset + 7);
2329
  bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, l32r_offset (got_base + lit_offset,
2330
                                       plt_base + code_offset + 9),
2331
              splt->contents + code_offset + 10);
2332
 
2333
  return plt_base + code_offset;
2334
}
2335
 
2336
 
2337
static bfd_boolean get_indirect_call_dest_reg (xtensa_opcode, unsigned *);
2338
 
2339
static bfd_boolean
2340
replace_tls_insn (Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
2341
                  bfd *abfd,
2342
                  asection *input_section,
2343
                  bfd_byte *contents,
2344
                  bfd_boolean is_ld_model,
2345
                  char **error_message)
2346
{
2347
  static xtensa_insnbuf ibuff = NULL;
2348
  static xtensa_insnbuf sbuff = NULL;
2349
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
2350
  xtensa_format fmt;
2351
  xtensa_opcode old_op, new_op;
2352
  bfd_size_type input_size;
2353
  int r_type;
2354
  unsigned dest_reg, src_reg;
2355
 
2356
  if (ibuff == NULL)
2357
    {
2358
      ibuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
2359
      sbuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
2360
    }
2361
 
2362
  input_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section);
2363
 
2364
  /* Read the instruction into a buffer and decode the opcode.  */
2365
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, ibuff, contents + rel->r_offset,
2366
                             input_size - rel->r_offset);
2367
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, ibuff);
2368
  if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2369
    {
2370
      *error_message = "cannot decode instruction format";
2371
      return FALSE;
2372
    }
2373
 
2374
  BFD_ASSERT (xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt) == 1);
2375
  xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, ibuff, sbuff);
2376
 
2377
  old_op = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff);
2378
  if (old_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2379
    {
2380
      *error_message = "cannot decode instruction opcode";
2381
      return FALSE;
2382
    }
2383
 
2384
  r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2385
  switch (r_type)
2386
    {
2387
    case R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
2388
    case R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
2389
      if (old_op != get_l32r_opcode ()
2390
          || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, old_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2391
                                       sbuff, &dest_reg) != 0)
2392
        {
2393
          *error_message = "cannot extract L32R destination for TLS access";
2394
          return FALSE;
2395
        }
2396
      break;
2397
 
2398
    case R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
2399
      if (! get_indirect_call_dest_reg (old_op, &dest_reg)
2400
          || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, old_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2401
                                       sbuff, &src_reg) != 0)
2402
        {
2403
          *error_message = "cannot extract CALLXn operands for TLS access";
2404
          return FALSE;
2405
        }
2406
      break;
2407
 
2408
    default:
2409
      abort ();
2410
    }
2411
 
2412
  if (is_ld_model)
2413
    {
2414
      switch (r_type)
2415
        {
2416
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
2417
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
2418
          /* Change the instruction to a NOP (or "OR a1, a1, a1" for older
2419
             versions of Xtensa).  */
2420
          new_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "nop");
2421
          if (new_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
2422
            {
2423
              new_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "or");
2424
              if (new_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
2425
                  || xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff, new_op) != 0
2426
                  || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2427
                                               sbuff, 1) != 0
2428
                  || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 1, fmt, 0,
2429
                                               sbuff, 1) != 0
2430
                  || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 2, fmt, 0,
2431
                                               sbuff, 1) != 0)
2432
                {
2433
                  *error_message = "cannot encode OR for TLS access";
2434
                  return FALSE;
2435
                }
2436
            }
2437
          else
2438
            {
2439
              if (xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff, new_op) != 0)
2440
                {
2441
                  *error_message = "cannot encode NOP for TLS access";
2442
                  return FALSE;
2443
                }
2444
            }
2445
          break;
2446
 
2447
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
2448
          /* Read THREADPTR into the CALLX's return value register.  */
2449
          new_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "rur.threadptr");
2450
          if (new_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
2451
              || xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff, new_op) != 0
2452
              || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2453
                                           sbuff, dest_reg + 2) != 0)
2454
            {
2455
              *error_message = "cannot encode RUR.THREADPTR for TLS access";
2456
              return FALSE;
2457
            }
2458
          break;
2459
        }
2460
    }
2461
  else
2462
    {
2463
      switch (r_type)
2464
        {
2465
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
2466
          new_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "rur.threadptr");
2467
          if (new_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
2468
              || xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff, new_op) != 0
2469
              || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2470
                                           sbuff, dest_reg) != 0)
2471
            {
2472
              *error_message = "cannot encode RUR.THREADPTR for TLS access";
2473
              return FALSE;
2474
            }
2475
          break;
2476
 
2477
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
2478
          /* Nothing to do.  Keep the original L32R instruction.  */
2479
          return TRUE;
2480
 
2481
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
2482
          /* Add the CALLX's src register (holding the THREADPTR value)
2483
             to the first argument register (holding the offset) and put
2484
             the result in the CALLX's return value register.  */
2485
          new_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "add");
2486
          if (new_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
2487
              || xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, sbuff, new_op) != 0
2488
              || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 0, fmt, 0,
2489
                                           sbuff, dest_reg + 2) != 0
2490
              || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 1, fmt, 0,
2491
                                           sbuff, dest_reg + 2) != 0
2492
              || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, new_op, 2, fmt, 0,
2493
                                           sbuff, src_reg) != 0)
2494
            {
2495
              *error_message = "cannot encode ADD for TLS access";
2496
              return FALSE;
2497
            }
2498
          break;
2499
        }
2500
    }
2501
 
2502
  xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, fmt, 0, ibuff, sbuff);
2503
  xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, ibuff, contents + rel->r_offset,
2504
                           input_size - rel->r_offset);
2505
 
2506
  return TRUE;
2507
}
2508
 
2509
 
2510
#define IS_XTENSA_TLS_RELOC(R_TYPE) \
2511
  ((R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN \
2512
   || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG \
2513
   || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF \
2514
   || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF \
2515
   || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC \
2516
   || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG \
2517
   || (R_TYPE) == R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL)
2518
 
2519
/* Relocate an Xtensa ELF section.  This is invoked by the linker for
2520
   both relocatable and final links.  */
2521
 
2522
static bfd_boolean
2523
elf_xtensa_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
2524
                             struct bfd_link_info *info,
2525
                             bfd *input_bfd,
2526
                             asection *input_section,
2527
                             bfd_byte *contents,
2528
                             Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
2529
                             Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
2530
                             asection **local_sections)
2531
{
2532
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
2533
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2534
  Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2535
  Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
2536
  struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2537
  property_table_entry *lit_table = 0;
2538
  int ltblsize = 0;
2539
  char *local_got_tls_types;
2540
  char *error_message = NULL;
2541
  bfd_size_type input_size;
2542
  int tls_type;
2543
 
2544
  if (!xtensa_default_isa)
2545
    xtensa_default_isa = xtensa_isa_init (0, 0);
2546
 
2547
  BFD_ASSERT (is_xtensa_elf (input_bfd));
2548
 
2549
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
2550
  symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
2551
  sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
2552
  local_got_tls_types = elf_xtensa_local_got_tls_type (input_bfd);
2553
 
2554
  if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
2555
    {
2556
      ltblsize = xtensa_read_table_entries (input_bfd, input_section,
2557
                                            &lit_table, XTENSA_LIT_SEC_NAME,
2558
                                            TRUE);
2559
      if (ltblsize < 0)
2560
        return FALSE;
2561
    }
2562
 
2563
  input_size = bfd_get_section_limit (input_bfd, input_section);
2564
 
2565
  rel = relocs;
2566
  relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
2567
  for (; rel < relend; rel++)
2568
    {
2569
      int r_type;
2570
      reloc_howto_type *howto;
2571
      unsigned long r_symndx;
2572
      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2573
      Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
2574
      char sym_type;
2575
      const char *name;
2576
      asection *sec;
2577
      bfd_vma relocation;
2578
      bfd_reloc_status_type r;
2579
      bfd_boolean is_weak_undef;
2580
      bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc;
2581
      bfd_boolean warned;
2582
      bfd_boolean dynamic_symbol;
2583
 
2584
      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2585
      if (r_type == (int) R_XTENSA_GNU_VTINHERIT
2586
          || r_type == (int) R_XTENSA_GNU_VTENTRY)
2587
        continue;
2588
 
2589
      if (r_type < 0 || r_type >= (int) R_XTENSA_max)
2590
        {
2591
          bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2592
          return FALSE;
2593
        }
2594
      howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
2595
 
2596
      r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2597
 
2598
      h = NULL;
2599
      sym = NULL;
2600
      sec = NULL;
2601
      is_weak_undef = FALSE;
2602
      unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
2603
      warned = FALSE;
2604
 
2605
      if (howto->partial_inplace && !info->relocatable)
2606
        {
2607
          /* Because R_XTENSA_32 was made partial_inplace to fix some
2608
             problems with DWARF info in partial links, there may be
2609
             an addend stored in the contents.  Take it out of there
2610
             and move it back into the addend field of the reloc.  */
2611
          rel->r_addend += bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
2612
          bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, 0, contents + rel->r_offset);
2613
        }
2614
 
2615
      if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2616
        {
2617
          sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
2618
          sym_type = ELF32_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info);
2619
          sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
2620
          relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
2621
        }
2622
      else
2623
        {
2624
          RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
2625
                                   r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
2626
                                   h, sec, relocation,
2627
                                   unresolved_reloc, warned);
2628
 
2629
          if (relocation == 0
2630
              && !unresolved_reloc
2631
              && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
2632
            is_weak_undef = TRUE;
2633
 
2634
          sym_type = h->type;
2635
        }
2636
 
2637
      if (sec != NULL && elf_discarded_section (sec))
2638
        {
2639
          /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
2640
             or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
2641
             section contents zeroed.  Avoid any special processing.  */
2642
          _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
2643
          rel->r_info = 0;
2644
          rel->r_addend = 0;
2645
          continue;
2646
        }
2647
 
2648
      if (info->relocatable)
2649
        {
2650
          /* This is a relocatable link.
2651
             1) If the reloc is against a section symbol, adjust
2652
             according to the output section.
2653
             2) If there is a new target for this relocation,
2654
             the new target will be in the same output section.
2655
             We adjust the relocation by the output section
2656
             difference.  */
2657
 
2658
          if (relaxing_section)
2659
            {
2660
              /* Check if this references a section in another input file.  */
2661
              if (!do_fix_for_relocatable_link (rel, input_bfd, input_section,
2662
                                                contents))
2663
                return FALSE;
2664
            }
2665
 
2666
          if (r_type == R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY)
2667
            {
2668
              char *error_message = NULL;
2669
              /* Convert ASM_SIMPLIFY into the simpler relocation
2670
                 so that they never escape a relaxing link.  */
2671
              r = contract_asm_expansion (contents, input_size, rel,
2672
                                          &error_message);
2673
              if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
2674
                {
2675
                  if (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
2676
                        (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
2677
                         rel->r_offset)))
2678
                    return FALSE;
2679
                }
2680
              r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2681
            }
2682
 
2683
          /* This is a relocatable link, so we don't have to change
2684
             anything unless the reloc is against a section symbol,
2685
             in which case we have to adjust according to where the
2686
             section symbol winds up in the output section.  */
2687
          if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2688
            {
2689
              sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
2690
              if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
2691
                {
2692
                  sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
2693
                  rel->r_addend += sec->output_offset + sym->st_value;
2694
                }
2695
            }
2696
 
2697
          /* If there is an addend with a partial_inplace howto,
2698
             then move the addend to the contents.  This is a hack
2699
             to work around problems with DWARF in relocatable links
2700
             with some previous version of BFD.  Now we can't easily get
2701
             rid of the hack without breaking backward compatibility.... */
2702
          if (rel->r_addend)
2703
            {
2704
              howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
2705
              if (howto->partial_inplace)
2706
                {
2707
                  r = elf_xtensa_do_reloc (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
2708
                                           rel->r_addend, contents,
2709
                                           rel->r_offset, FALSE,
2710
                                           &error_message);
2711
                  if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
2712
                    {
2713
                      if (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
2714
                            (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
2715
                             rel->r_offset)))
2716
                        return FALSE;
2717
                    }
2718
                  rel->r_addend = 0;
2719
                }
2720
            }
2721
 
2722
          /* Done with work for relocatable link; continue with next reloc.  */
2723
          continue;
2724
        }
2725
 
2726
      /* This is a final link.  */
2727
 
2728
      if (relaxing_section)
2729
        {
2730
          /* Check if this references a section in another input file.  */
2731
          do_fix_for_final_link (rel, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
2732
                                 &relocation);
2733
        }
2734
 
2735
      /* Sanity check the address.  */
2736
      if (rel->r_offset >= input_size
2737
          && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_NONE)
2738
        {
2739
          (*_bfd_error_handler)
2740
            (_("%B(%A+0x%lx): relocation offset out of range (size=0x%x)"),
2741
             input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, input_size);
2742
          bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2743
          return FALSE;
2744
        }
2745
 
2746
      if (h != NULL)
2747
        name = h->root.root.string;
2748
      else
2749
        {
2750
          name = (bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section
2751
                  (input_bfd, symtab_hdr->sh_link, sym->st_name));
2752
          if (name == NULL || *name == '\0')
2753
            name = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec);
2754
        }
2755
 
2756
      if (r_symndx != 0
2757
          && r_type != R_XTENSA_NONE
2758
          && (h == NULL
2759
              || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2760
              || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2761
          && IS_XTENSA_TLS_RELOC (r_type) != (sym_type == STT_TLS))
2762
        {
2763
          (*_bfd_error_handler)
2764
            ((sym_type == STT_TLS
2765
              ? _("%B(%A+0x%lx): %s used with TLS symbol %s")
2766
              : _("%B(%A+0x%lx): %s used with non-TLS symbol %s")),
2767
             input_bfd,
2768
             input_section,
2769
             (long) rel->r_offset,
2770
             howto->name,
2771
             name);
2772
        }
2773
 
2774
      dynamic_symbol = elf_xtensa_dynamic_symbol_p (h, info);
2775
 
2776
      tls_type = GOT_UNKNOWN;
2777
      if (h)
2778
        tls_type = elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h)->tls_type;
2779
      else if (local_got_tls_types)
2780
        tls_type = local_got_tls_types [r_symndx];
2781
 
2782
      switch (r_type)
2783
        {
2784
        case R_XTENSA_32:
2785
        case R_XTENSA_PLT:
2786
          if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
2787
              && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
2788
              && (dynamic_symbol || info->shared))
2789
            {
2790
              Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
2791
              bfd_byte *loc;
2792
              asection *srel;
2793
 
2794
              if (dynamic_symbol && r_type == R_XTENSA_PLT)
2795
                srel = htab->srelplt;
2796
              else
2797
                srel = htab->srelgot;
2798
 
2799
              BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
2800
 
2801
              outrel.r_offset =
2802
                _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
2803
                                         input_section, rel->r_offset);
2804
 
2805
              if ((outrel.r_offset | 1) == (bfd_vma) -1)
2806
                memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
2807
              else
2808
                {
2809
                  outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
2810
                                      + input_section->output_offset);
2811
 
2812
                  /* Complain if the relocation is in a read-only section
2813
                     and not in a literal pool.  */
2814
                  if ((input_section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
2815
                      && !elf_xtensa_in_literal_pool (lit_table, ltblsize,
2816
                                                      outrel.r_offset))
2817
                    {
2818
                      error_message =
2819
                        _("dynamic relocation in read-only section");
2820
                      if (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
2821
                            (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
2822
                             rel->r_offset)))
2823
                        return FALSE;
2824
                    }
2825
 
2826
                  if (dynamic_symbol)
2827
                    {
2828
                      outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
2829
                      rel->r_addend = 0;
2830
 
2831
                      if (r_type == R_XTENSA_32)
2832
                        {
2833
                          outrel.r_info =
2834
                            ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_XTENSA_GLOB_DAT);
2835
                          relocation = 0;
2836
                        }
2837
                      else /* r_type == R_XTENSA_PLT */
2838
                        {
2839
                          outrel.r_info =
2840
                            ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT);
2841
 
2842
                          /* Create the PLT entry and set the initial
2843
                             contents of the literal entry to the address of
2844
                             the PLT entry.  */
2845
                          relocation =
2846
                            elf_xtensa_create_plt_entry (info, output_bfd,
2847
                                                         srel->reloc_count);
2848
                        }
2849
                      unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
2850
                    }
2851
                  else
2852
                    {
2853
                      /* Generate a RELATIVE relocation.  */
2854
                      outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_RELATIVE);
2855
                      outrel.r_addend = 0;
2856
                    }
2857
                }
2858
 
2859
              loc = (srel->contents
2860
                     + srel->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
2861
              bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
2862
              BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) * srel->reloc_count
2863
                          <= srel->size);
2864
            }
2865
          else if (r_type == R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND && dynamic_symbol)
2866
            {
2867
              /* This should only happen for non-PIC code, which is not
2868
                 supposed to be used on systems with dynamic linking.
2869
                 Just ignore these relocations.  */
2870
              continue;
2871
            }
2872
          break;
2873
 
2874
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF:
2875
          /* Switch to LE model for local symbols in an executable.  */
2876
          if (! info->shared && ! dynamic_symbol)
2877
            {
2878
              relocation = tpoff (info, relocation);
2879
              break;
2880
            }
2881
          /* fall through */
2882
 
2883
        case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN:
2884
        case R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG:
2885
          {
2886
            if (r_type == R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_FN)
2887
              {
2888
                if (! info->shared || (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) != 0)
2889
                  r_type = R_XTENSA_NONE;
2890
              }
2891
            else if (r_type == R_XTENSA_TLSDESC_ARG)
2892
              {
2893
                if (info->shared)
2894
                  {
2895
                    if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) != 0)
2896
                      r_type = R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF;
2897
                  }
2898
                else
2899
                  {
2900
                    r_type = R_XTENSA_TLS_TPOFF;
2901
                    if (! dynamic_symbol)
2902
                      {
2903
                        relocation = tpoff (info, relocation);
2904
                        break;
2905
                      }
2906
                  }
2907
              }
2908
 
2909
            if (r_type == R_XTENSA_NONE)
2910
              /* Nothing to do here; skip to the next reloc.  */
2911
              continue;
2912
 
2913
            if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
2914
              {
2915
                error_message =
2916
                  _("TLS relocation invalid without dynamic sections");
2917
                if (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
2918
                      (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
2919
                       rel->r_offset)))
2920
                  return FALSE;
2921
              }
2922
            else
2923
              {
2924
                Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
2925
                bfd_byte *loc;
2926
                asection *srel = htab->srelgot;
2927
                int indx;
2928
 
2929
                outrel.r_offset = (input_section->output_section->vma
2930
                                   + input_section->output_offset
2931
                                   + rel->r_offset);
2932
 
2933
                /* Complain if the relocation is in a read-only section
2934
                   and not in a literal pool.  */
2935
                if ((input_section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
2936
                    && ! elf_xtensa_in_literal_pool (lit_table, ltblsize,
2937
                                                     outrel.r_offset))
2938
                  {
2939
                    error_message =
2940
                      _("dynamic relocation in read-only section");
2941
                    if (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
2942
                          (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
2943
                           rel->r_offset)))
2944
                      return FALSE;
2945
                  }
2946
 
2947
                indx = h && h->dynindx != -1 ? h->dynindx : 0;
2948
                if (indx == 0)
2949
                  outrel.r_addend = relocation - dtpoff_base (info);
2950
                else
2951
                  outrel.r_addend = 0;
2952
                rel->r_addend = 0;
2953
 
2954
                outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
2955
                relocation = 0;
2956
                unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
2957
 
2958
                BFD_ASSERT (srel);
2959
                loc = (srel->contents
2960
                       + srel->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
2961
                bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
2962
                BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) * srel->reloc_count
2963
                            <= srel->size);
2964
              }
2965
          }
2966
          break;
2967
 
2968
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_DTPOFF:
2969
          if (! info->shared)
2970
            /* Switch from LD model to LE model.  */
2971
            relocation = tpoff (info, relocation);
2972
          else
2973
            relocation -= dtpoff_base (info);
2974
          break;
2975
 
2976
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_FUNC:
2977
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG:
2978
        case R_XTENSA_TLS_CALL:
2979
          /* Check if optimizing to IE or LE model.  */
2980
          if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE) != 0)
2981
            {
2982
              bfd_boolean is_ld_model =
2983
                (h && elf_xtensa_hash_entry (h) == htab->tlsbase);
2984
              if (! replace_tls_insn (rel, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
2985
                                      is_ld_model, &error_message))
2986
                {
2987
                  if (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
2988
                        (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
2989
                         rel->r_offset)))
2990
                    return FALSE;
2991
                }
2992
 
2993
              if (r_type != R_XTENSA_TLS_ARG || is_ld_model)
2994
                {
2995
                  /* Skip subsequent relocations on the same instruction.  */
2996
                  while (rel + 1 < relend && rel[1].r_offset == rel->r_offset)
2997
                    rel++;
2998
                }
2999
            }
3000
          continue;
3001
 
3002
        default:
3003
          if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
3004
              && dynamic_symbol && (is_operand_relocation (r_type)
3005
                                    || r_type == R_XTENSA_32_PCREL))
3006
            {
3007
              error_message =
3008
                vsprint_msg ("invalid relocation for dynamic symbol", ": %s",
3009
                             strlen (name) + 2, name);
3010
              if (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
3011
                    (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
3012
                     rel->r_offset)))
3013
                return FALSE;
3014
              continue;
3015
            }
3016
          break;
3017
        }
3018
 
3019
      /* Dynamic relocs are not propagated for SEC_DEBUGGING sections
3020
         because such sections are not SEC_ALLOC and thus ld.so will
3021
         not process them.  */
3022
      if (unresolved_reloc
3023
          && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
3024
               && h->def_dynamic))
3025
        {
3026
          (*_bfd_error_handler)
3027
            (_("%B(%A+0x%lx): unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'"),
3028
             input_bfd,
3029
             input_section,
3030
             (long) rel->r_offset,
3031
             howto->name,
3032
             name);
3033
          return FALSE;
3034
        }
3035
 
3036
      /* TLS optimizations may have changed r_type; update "howto".  */
3037
      howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
3038
 
3039
      /* There's no point in calling bfd_perform_relocation here.
3040
         Just go directly to our "special function".  */
3041
      r = elf_xtensa_do_reloc (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
3042
                               relocation + rel->r_addend,
3043
                               contents, rel->r_offset, is_weak_undef,
3044
                               &error_message);
3045
 
3046
      if (r != bfd_reloc_ok && !warned)
3047
        {
3048
          BFD_ASSERT (r == bfd_reloc_dangerous || r == bfd_reloc_other);
3049
          BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL);
3050
 
3051
          if (rel->r_addend == 0)
3052
            error_message = vsprint_msg (error_message, ": %s",
3053
                                         strlen (name) + 2, name);
3054
          else
3055
            error_message = vsprint_msg (error_message, ": (%s+0x%x)",
3056
                                         strlen (name) + 22,
3057
                                         name, (int) rel->r_addend);
3058
 
3059
          if (!((*info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
3060
                (info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
3061
                 rel->r_offset)))
3062
            return FALSE;
3063
        }
3064
    }
3065
 
3066
  if (lit_table)
3067
    free (lit_table);
3068
 
3069
  input_section->reloc_done = TRUE;
3070
 
3071
  return TRUE;
3072
}
3073
 
3074
 
3075
/* Finish up dynamic symbol handling.  There's not much to do here since
3076
   the PLT and GOT entries are all set up by relocate_section.  */
3077
 
3078
static bfd_boolean
3079
elf_xtensa_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3080
                                  struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3081
                                  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3082
                                  Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
3083
{
3084
  if (h->needs_plt && !h->def_regular)
3085
    {
3086
      /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as defined in
3087
         the .plt section.  Leave the value alone.  */
3088
      sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
3089
      /* If the symbol is weak, we do need to clear the value.
3090
         Otherwise, the PLT entry would provide a definition for
3091
         the symbol even if the symbol wasn't defined anywhere,
3092
         and so the symbol would never be NULL.  */
3093
      if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
3094
        sym->st_value = 0;
3095
    }
3096
 
3097
  /* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute.  */
3098
  if (strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_DYNAMIC") == 0
3099
      || h == elf_hash_table (info)->hgot)
3100
    sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
3101
 
3102
  return TRUE;
3103
}
3104
 
3105
 
3106
/* Combine adjacent literal table entries in the output.  Adjacent
3107
   entries within each input section may have been removed during
3108
   relaxation, but we repeat the process here, even though it's too late
3109
   to shrink the output section, because it's important to minimize the
3110
   number of literal table entries to reduce the start-up work for the
3111
   runtime linker.  Returns the number of remaining table entries or -1
3112
   on error.  */
3113
 
3114
static int
3115
elf_xtensa_combine_prop_entries (bfd *output_bfd,
3116
                                 asection *sxtlit,
3117
                                 asection *sgotloc)
3118
{
3119
  bfd_byte *contents;
3120
  property_table_entry *table;
3121
  bfd_size_type section_size, sgotloc_size;
3122
  bfd_vma offset;
3123
  int n, m, num;
3124
 
3125
  section_size = sxtlit->size;
3126
  BFD_ASSERT (section_size % 8 == 0);
3127
  num = section_size / 8;
3128
 
3129
  sgotloc_size = sgotloc->size;
3130
  if (sgotloc_size != section_size)
3131
    {
3132
      (*_bfd_error_handler)
3133
        (_("internal inconsistency in size of .got.loc section"));
3134
      return -1;
3135
    }
3136
 
3137
  table = bfd_malloc (num * sizeof (property_table_entry));
3138
  if (table == 0)
3139
    return -1;
3140
 
3141
  /* The ".xt.lit.plt" section has the SEC_IN_MEMORY flag set and this
3142
     propagates to the output section, where it doesn't really apply and
3143
     where it breaks the following call to bfd_malloc_and_get_section.  */
3144
  sxtlit->flags &= ~SEC_IN_MEMORY;
3145
 
3146
  if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (output_bfd, sxtlit, &contents))
3147
    {
3148
      if (contents != 0)
3149
        free (contents);
3150
      free (table);
3151
      return -1;
3152
    }
3153
 
3154
  /* There should never be any relocations left at this point, so this
3155
     is quite a bit easier than what is done during relaxation.  */
3156
 
3157
  /* Copy the raw contents into a property table array and sort it.  */
3158
  offset = 0;
3159
  for (n = 0; n < num; n++)
3160
    {
3161
      table[n].address = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, &contents[offset]);
3162
      table[n].size = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, &contents[offset + 4]);
3163
      offset += 8;
3164
    }
3165
  qsort (table, num, sizeof (property_table_entry), property_table_compare);
3166
 
3167
  for (n = 0; n < num; n++)
3168
    {
3169
      bfd_boolean remove = FALSE;
3170
 
3171
      if (table[n].size == 0)
3172
        remove = TRUE;
3173
      else if (n > 0 &&
3174
               (table[n-1].address + table[n-1].size == table[n].address))
3175
        {
3176
          table[n-1].size += table[n].size;
3177
          remove = TRUE;
3178
        }
3179
 
3180
      if (remove)
3181
        {
3182
          for (m = n; m < num - 1; m++)
3183
            {
3184
              table[m].address = table[m+1].address;
3185
              table[m].size = table[m+1].size;
3186
            }
3187
 
3188
          n--;
3189
          num--;
3190
        }
3191
    }
3192
 
3193
  /* Copy the data back to the raw contents.  */
3194
  offset = 0;
3195
  for (n = 0; n < num; n++)
3196
    {
3197
      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, table[n].address, &contents[offset]);
3198
      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, table[n].size, &contents[offset + 4]);
3199
      offset += 8;
3200
    }
3201
 
3202
  /* Clear the removed bytes.  */
3203
  if ((bfd_size_type) (num * 8) < section_size)
3204
    memset (&contents[num * 8], 0, section_size - num * 8);
3205
 
3206
  if (! bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sxtlit, contents, 0,
3207
                                  section_size))
3208
    return -1;
3209
 
3210
  /* Copy the contents to ".got.loc".  */
3211
  memcpy (sgotloc->contents, contents, section_size);
3212
 
3213
  free (contents);
3214
  free (table);
3215
  return num;
3216
}
3217
 
3218
 
3219
/* Finish up the dynamic sections.  */
3220
 
3221
static bfd_boolean
3222
elf_xtensa_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
3223
                                    struct bfd_link_info *info)
3224
{
3225
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
3226
  bfd *dynobj;
3227
  asection *sdyn, *srelplt, *sgot, *sxtlit, *sgotloc;
3228
  Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
3229
  int num_xtlit_entries = 0;
3230
 
3231
  if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
3232
    return TRUE;
3233
 
3234
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
3235
  dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
3236
  sdyn = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".dynamic");
3237
  BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
3238
 
3239
  /* Set the first entry in the global offset table to the address of
3240
     the dynamic section.  */
3241
  sgot = htab->sgot;
3242
  if (sgot)
3243
    {
3244
      BFD_ASSERT (sgot->size == 4);
3245
      if (sdyn == NULL)
3246
        bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents);
3247
      else
3248
        bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
3249
                    sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset,
3250
                    sgot->contents);
3251
    }
3252
 
3253
  srelplt = htab->srelplt;
3254
  if (srelplt && srelplt->size != 0)
3255
    {
3256
      asection *sgotplt, *srelgot, *spltlittbl;
3257
      int chunk, plt_chunks, plt_entries;
3258
      Elf_Internal_Rela irela;
3259
      bfd_byte *loc;
3260
      unsigned rtld_reloc;
3261
 
3262
      srelgot = htab->srelgot;
3263
      spltlittbl = htab->spltlittbl;
3264
      BFD_ASSERT (srelgot != NULL && spltlittbl != NULL);
3265
 
3266
      /* Find the first XTENSA_RTLD relocation.  Presumably the rest
3267
         of them follow immediately after....  */
3268
      for (rtld_reloc = 0; rtld_reloc < srelgot->reloc_count; rtld_reloc++)
3269
        {
3270
          loc = srelgot->contents + rtld_reloc * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
3271
          bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &irela);
3272
          if (ELF32_R_TYPE (irela.r_info) == R_XTENSA_RTLD)
3273
            break;
3274
        }
3275
      BFD_ASSERT (rtld_reloc < srelgot->reloc_count);
3276
 
3277
      plt_entries = srelplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
3278
      plt_chunks =
3279
        (plt_entries + PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK - 1) / PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
3280
 
3281
      for (chunk = 0; chunk < plt_chunks; chunk++)
3282
        {
3283
          int chunk_entries = 0;
3284
 
3285
          sgotplt = elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (info, chunk);
3286
          BFD_ASSERT (sgotplt != NULL);
3287
 
3288
          /* Emit special RTLD relocations for the first two entries in
3289
             each chunk of the .got.plt section.  */
3290
 
3291
          loc = srelgot->contents + rtld_reloc * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
3292
          bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &irela);
3293
          BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (irela.r_info) == R_XTENSA_RTLD);
3294
          irela.r_offset = (sgotplt->output_section->vma
3295
                            + sgotplt->output_offset);
3296
          irela.r_addend = 1; /* tell rtld to set value to resolver function */
3297
          bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &irela, loc);
3298
          rtld_reloc += 1;
3299
          BFD_ASSERT (rtld_reloc <= srelgot->reloc_count);
3300
 
3301
          /* Next literal immediately follows the first.  */
3302
          loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
3303
          bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &irela);
3304
          BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (irela.r_info) == R_XTENSA_RTLD);
3305
          irela.r_offset = (sgotplt->output_section->vma
3306
                            + sgotplt->output_offset + 4);
3307
          /* Tell rtld to set value to object's link map.  */
3308
          irela.r_addend = 2;
3309
          bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &irela, loc);
3310
          rtld_reloc += 1;
3311
          BFD_ASSERT (rtld_reloc <= srelgot->reloc_count);
3312
 
3313
          /* Fill in the literal table.  */
3314
          if (chunk < plt_chunks - 1)
3315
            chunk_entries = PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
3316
          else
3317
            chunk_entries = plt_entries - (chunk * PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK);
3318
 
3319
          BFD_ASSERT ((unsigned) (chunk + 1) * 8 <= spltlittbl->size);
3320
          bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
3321
                      sgotplt->output_section->vma + sgotplt->output_offset,
3322
                      spltlittbl->contents + (chunk * 8) + 0);
3323
          bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
3324
                      8 + (chunk_entries * 4),
3325
                      spltlittbl->contents + (chunk * 8) + 4);
3326
        }
3327
 
3328
      /* All the dynamic relocations have been emitted at this point.
3329
         Make sure the relocation sections are the correct size.  */
3330
      if (srelgot->size != (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
3331
                            * srelgot->reloc_count)
3332
          || srelplt->size != (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
3333
                               * srelplt->reloc_count))
3334
        abort ();
3335
 
3336
     /* The .xt.lit.plt section has just been modified.  This must
3337
        happen before the code below which combines adjacent literal
3338
        table entries, and the .xt.lit.plt contents have to be forced to
3339
        the output here.  */
3340
      if (! bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd,
3341
                                      spltlittbl->output_section,
3342
                                      spltlittbl->contents,
3343
                                      spltlittbl->output_offset,
3344
                                      spltlittbl->size))
3345
        return FALSE;
3346
      /* Clear SEC_HAS_CONTENTS so the contents won't be output again.  */
3347
      spltlittbl->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
3348
    }
3349
 
3350
  /* Combine adjacent literal table entries.  */
3351
  BFD_ASSERT (! info->relocatable);
3352
  sxtlit = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".xt.lit");
3353
  sgotloc = htab->sgotloc;
3354
  BFD_ASSERT (sgotloc);
3355
  if (sxtlit)
3356
    {
3357
      num_xtlit_entries =
3358
        elf_xtensa_combine_prop_entries (output_bfd, sxtlit, sgotloc);
3359
      if (num_xtlit_entries < 0)
3360
        return FALSE;
3361
    }
3362
 
3363
  dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
3364
  dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
3365
  for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
3366
    {
3367
      Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
3368
 
3369
      bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
3370
 
3371
      switch (dyn.d_tag)
3372
        {
3373
        default:
3374
          break;
3375
 
3376
        case DT_XTENSA_GOT_LOC_SZ:
3377
          dyn.d_un.d_val = num_xtlit_entries;
3378
          break;
3379
 
3380
        case DT_XTENSA_GOT_LOC_OFF:
3381
          dyn.d_un.d_ptr = htab->sgotloc->output_section->vma;
3382
          break;
3383
 
3384
        case DT_PLTGOT:
3385
          dyn.d_un.d_ptr = htab->sgot->output_section->vma;
3386
          break;
3387
 
3388
        case DT_JMPREL:
3389
          dyn.d_un.d_ptr = htab->srelplt->output_section->vma;
3390
          break;
3391
 
3392
        case DT_PLTRELSZ:
3393
          dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->srelplt->output_section->size;
3394
          break;
3395
 
3396
        case DT_RELASZ:
3397
          /* Adjust RELASZ to not include JMPREL.  This matches what
3398
             glibc expects and what is done for several other ELF
3399
             targets (e.g., i386, alpha), but the "correct" behavior
3400
             seems to be unresolved.  Since the linker script arranges
3401
             for .rela.plt to follow all other relocation sections, we
3402
             don't have to worry about changing the DT_RELA entry.  */
3403
          if (htab->srelplt)
3404
            dyn.d_un.d_val -= htab->srelplt->output_section->size;
3405
          break;
3406
        }
3407
 
3408
      bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
3409
    }
3410
 
3411
  return TRUE;
3412
}
3413
 
3414
 
3415
/* Functions for dealing with the e_flags field.  */
3416
 
3417
/* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3418
   object file when linking.  */
3419
 
3420
static bfd_boolean
3421
elf_xtensa_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
3422
{
3423
  unsigned out_mach, in_mach;
3424
  flagword out_flag, in_flag;
3425
 
3426
  /* Check if we have the same endianess.  */
3427
  if (!_bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, obfd))
3428
    return FALSE;
3429
 
3430
  /* Don't even pretend to support mixed-format linking.  */
3431
  if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
3432
      || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
3433
    return FALSE;
3434
 
3435
  out_flag = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3436
  in_flag = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3437
 
3438
  out_mach = out_flag & EF_XTENSA_MACH;
3439
  in_mach = in_flag & EF_XTENSA_MACH;
3440
  if (out_mach != in_mach)
3441
    {
3442
      (*_bfd_error_handler)
3443
        (_("%B: incompatible machine type. Output is 0x%x. Input is 0x%x"),
3444
         ibfd, out_mach, in_mach);
3445
      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
3446
      return FALSE;
3447
    }
3448
 
3449
  if (! elf_flags_init (obfd))
3450
    {
3451
      elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
3452
      elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = in_flag;
3453
 
3454
      if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd)
3455
          && bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default)
3456
        return bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd),
3457
                                  bfd_get_mach (ibfd));
3458
 
3459
      return TRUE;
3460
    }
3461
 
3462
  if ((out_flag & EF_XTENSA_XT_INSN) != (in_flag & EF_XTENSA_XT_INSN))
3463
    elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= (~ EF_XTENSA_XT_INSN);
3464
 
3465
  if ((out_flag & EF_XTENSA_XT_LIT) != (in_flag & EF_XTENSA_XT_LIT))
3466
    elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= (~ EF_XTENSA_XT_LIT);
3467
 
3468
  return TRUE;
3469
}
3470
 
3471
 
3472
static bfd_boolean
3473
elf_xtensa_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
3474
{
3475
  BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
3476
              || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
3477
 
3478
  elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= flags;
3479
  elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
3480
 
3481
  return TRUE;
3482
}
3483
 
3484
 
3485
static bfd_boolean
3486
elf_xtensa_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
3487
{
3488
  FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
3489
  flagword e_flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags;
3490
 
3491
  fprintf (f, "\nXtensa header:\n");
3492
  if ((e_flags & EF_XTENSA_MACH) == E_XTENSA_MACH)
3493
    fprintf (f, "\nMachine     = Base\n");
3494
  else
3495
    fprintf (f, "\nMachine Id  = 0x%x\n", e_flags & EF_XTENSA_MACH);
3496
 
3497
  fprintf (f, "Insn tables = %s\n",
3498
           (e_flags & EF_XTENSA_XT_INSN) ? "true" : "false");
3499
 
3500
  fprintf (f, "Literal tables = %s\n",
3501
           (e_flags & EF_XTENSA_XT_LIT) ? "true" : "false");
3502
 
3503
  return _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, farg);
3504
}
3505
 
3506
 
3507
/* Set the right machine number for an Xtensa ELF file.  */
3508
 
3509
static bfd_boolean
3510
elf_xtensa_object_p (bfd *abfd)
3511
{
3512
  int mach;
3513
  unsigned long arch = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_XTENSA_MACH;
3514
 
3515
  switch (arch)
3516
    {
3517
    case E_XTENSA_MACH:
3518
      mach = bfd_mach_xtensa;
3519
      break;
3520
    default:
3521
      return FALSE;
3522
    }
3523
 
3524
  (void) bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, bfd_arch_xtensa, mach);
3525
  return TRUE;
3526
}
3527
 
3528
 
3529
/* The final processing done just before writing out an Xtensa ELF object
3530
   file.  This gets the Xtensa architecture right based on the machine
3531
   number.  */
3532
 
3533
static void
3534
elf_xtensa_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd,
3535
                                   bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3536
{
3537
  int mach;
3538
  unsigned long val;
3539
 
3540
  switch (mach = bfd_get_mach (abfd))
3541
    {
3542
    case bfd_mach_xtensa:
3543
      val = E_XTENSA_MACH;
3544
      break;
3545
    default:
3546
      return;
3547
    }
3548
 
3549
  elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &=  (~ EF_XTENSA_MACH);
3550
  elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= val;
3551
}
3552
 
3553
 
3554
static enum elf_reloc_type_class
3555
elf_xtensa_reloc_type_class (const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
3556
{
3557
  switch ((int) ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
3558
    {
3559
    case R_XTENSA_RELATIVE:
3560
      return reloc_class_relative;
3561
    case R_XTENSA_JMP_SLOT:
3562
      return reloc_class_plt;
3563
    default:
3564
      return reloc_class_normal;
3565
    }
3566
}
3567
 
3568
 
3569
static bfd_boolean
3570
elf_xtensa_discard_info_for_section (bfd *abfd,
3571
                                     struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
3572
                                     struct bfd_link_info *info,
3573
                                     asection *sec)
3574
{
3575
  bfd_byte *contents;
3576
  bfd_vma offset, actual_offset;
3577
  bfd_size_type removed_bytes = 0;
3578
  bfd_size_type entry_size;
3579
 
3580
  if (sec->output_section
3581
      && bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
3582
    return FALSE;
3583
 
3584
  if (xtensa_is_proptable_section (sec))
3585
    entry_size = 12;
3586
  else
3587
    entry_size = 8;
3588
 
3589
  if (sec->size == 0 || sec->size % entry_size != 0)
3590
    return FALSE;
3591
 
3592
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, info->keep_memory);
3593
  if (!contents)
3594
    return FALSE;
3595
 
3596
  cookie->rels = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec, info->keep_memory);
3597
  if (!cookie->rels)
3598
    {
3599
      release_contents (sec, contents);
3600
      return FALSE;
3601
    }
3602
 
3603
  /* Sort the relocations.  They should already be in order when
3604
     relaxation is enabled, but it might not be.  */
3605
  qsort (cookie->rels, sec->reloc_count, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela),
3606
         internal_reloc_compare);
3607
 
3608
  cookie->rel = cookie->rels;
3609
  cookie->relend = cookie->rels + sec->reloc_count;
3610
 
3611
  for (offset = 0; offset < sec->size; offset += entry_size)
3612
    {
3613
      actual_offset = offset - removed_bytes;
3614
 
3615
      /* The ...symbol_deleted_p function will skip over relocs but it
3616
         won't adjust their offsets, so do that here.  */
3617
      while (cookie->rel < cookie->relend
3618
             && cookie->rel->r_offset < offset)
3619
        {
3620
          cookie->rel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
3621
          cookie->rel++;
3622
        }
3623
 
3624
      while (cookie->rel < cookie->relend
3625
             && cookie->rel->r_offset == offset)
3626
        {
3627
          if (bfd_elf_reloc_symbol_deleted_p (offset, cookie))
3628
            {
3629
              /* Remove the table entry.  (If the reloc type is NONE, then
3630
                 the entry has already been merged with another and deleted
3631
                 during relaxation.)  */
3632
              if (ELF32_R_TYPE (cookie->rel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_NONE)
3633
                {
3634
                  /* Shift the contents up.  */
3635
                  if (offset + entry_size < sec->size)
3636
                    memmove (&contents[actual_offset],
3637
                             &contents[actual_offset + entry_size],
3638
                             sec->size - offset - entry_size);
3639
                  removed_bytes += entry_size;
3640
                }
3641
 
3642
              /* Remove this relocation.  */
3643
              cookie->rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
3644
            }
3645
 
3646
          /* Adjust the relocation offset for previous removals.  This
3647
             should not be done before calling ...symbol_deleted_p
3648
             because it might mess up the offset comparisons there.
3649
             Make sure the offset doesn't underflow in the case where
3650
             the first entry is removed.  */
3651
          if (cookie->rel->r_offset >= removed_bytes)
3652
            cookie->rel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
3653
          else
3654
            cookie->rel->r_offset = 0;
3655
 
3656
          cookie->rel++;
3657
        }
3658
    }
3659
 
3660
  if (removed_bytes != 0)
3661
    {
3662
      /* Adjust any remaining relocs (shouldn't be any).  */
3663
      for (; cookie->rel < cookie->relend; cookie->rel++)
3664
        {
3665
          if (cookie->rel->r_offset >= removed_bytes)
3666
            cookie->rel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
3667
          else
3668
            cookie->rel->r_offset = 0;
3669
        }
3670
 
3671
      /* Clear the removed bytes.  */
3672
      memset (&contents[sec->size - removed_bytes], 0, removed_bytes);
3673
 
3674
      pin_contents (sec, contents);
3675
      pin_internal_relocs (sec, cookie->rels);
3676
 
3677
      /* Shrink size.  */
3678
      if (sec->rawsize == 0)
3679
        sec->rawsize = sec->size;
3680
      sec->size -= removed_bytes;
3681
 
3682
      if (xtensa_is_littable_section (sec))
3683
        {
3684
          asection *sgotloc = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info)->sgotloc;
3685
          if (sgotloc)
3686
            sgotloc->size -= removed_bytes;
3687
        }
3688
    }
3689
  else
3690
    {
3691
      release_contents (sec, contents);
3692
      release_internal_relocs (sec, cookie->rels);
3693
    }
3694
 
3695
  return (removed_bytes != 0);
3696
}
3697
 
3698
 
3699
static bfd_boolean
3700
elf_xtensa_discard_info (bfd *abfd,
3701
                         struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
3702
                         struct bfd_link_info *info)
3703
{
3704
  asection *sec;
3705
  bfd_boolean changed = FALSE;
3706
 
3707
  for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3708
    {
3709
      if (xtensa_is_property_section (sec))
3710
        {
3711
          if (elf_xtensa_discard_info_for_section (abfd, cookie, info, sec))
3712
            changed = TRUE;
3713
        }
3714
    }
3715
 
3716
  return changed;
3717
}
3718
 
3719
 
3720
static bfd_boolean
3721
elf_xtensa_ignore_discarded_relocs (asection *sec)
3722
{
3723
  return xtensa_is_property_section (sec);
3724
}
3725
 
3726
 
3727
static unsigned int
3728
elf_xtensa_action_discarded (asection *sec)
3729
{
3730
  if (strcmp (".xt_except_table", sec->name) == 0)
3731
    return 0;
3732
 
3733
  if (strcmp (".xt_except_desc", sec->name) == 0)
3734
    return 0;
3735
 
3736
  return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
3737
}
3738
 
3739
 
3740
/* Support for core dump NOTE sections.  */
3741
 
3742
static bfd_boolean
3743
elf_xtensa_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
3744
{
3745
  int offset;
3746
  unsigned int size;
3747
 
3748
  /* The size for Xtensa is variable, so don't try to recognize the format
3749
     based on the size.  Just assume this is GNU/Linux.  */
3750
 
3751
  /* pr_cursig */
3752
  elf_tdata (abfd)->core_signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
3753
 
3754
  /* pr_pid */
3755
  elf_tdata (abfd)->core_pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
3756
 
3757
  /* pr_reg */
3758
  offset = 72;
3759
  size = note->descsz - offset - 4;
3760
 
3761
  /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
3762
  return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
3763
                                          size, note->descpos + offset);
3764
}
3765
 
3766
 
3767
static bfd_boolean
3768
elf_xtensa_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
3769
{
3770
  switch (note->descsz)
3771
    {
3772
      default:
3773
        return FALSE;
3774
 
3775
      case 128:         /* GNU/Linux elf_prpsinfo */
3776
        elf_tdata (abfd)->core_program
3777
         = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
3778
        elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command
3779
         = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
3780
    }
3781
 
3782
  /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
3783
     onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
3784
     implementations, so strip it off if it exists.  */
3785
 
3786
  {
3787
    char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core_command;
3788
    int n = strlen (command);
3789
 
3790
    if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
3791
      command[n - 1] = '\0';
3792
  }
3793
 
3794
  return TRUE;
3795
}
3796
 
3797
 
3798
/* Generic Xtensa configurability stuff.  */
3799
 
3800
static xtensa_opcode callx0_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3801
static xtensa_opcode callx4_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3802
static xtensa_opcode callx8_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3803
static xtensa_opcode callx12_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3804
static xtensa_opcode call0_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3805
static xtensa_opcode call4_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3806
static xtensa_opcode call8_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3807
static xtensa_opcode call12_op = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3808
 
3809
static void
3810
init_call_opcodes (void)
3811
{
3812
  if (callx0_op == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
3813
    {
3814
      callx0_op  = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "callx0");
3815
      callx4_op  = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "callx4");
3816
      callx8_op  = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "callx8");
3817
      callx12_op = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "callx12");
3818
      call0_op   = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "call0");
3819
      call4_op   = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "call4");
3820
      call8_op   = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "call8");
3821
      call12_op  = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "call12");
3822
    }
3823
}
3824
 
3825
 
3826
static bfd_boolean
3827
is_indirect_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode opcode)
3828
{
3829
  init_call_opcodes ();
3830
  return (opcode == callx0_op
3831
          || opcode == callx4_op
3832
          || opcode == callx8_op
3833
          || opcode == callx12_op);
3834
}
3835
 
3836
 
3837
static bfd_boolean
3838
is_direct_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode opcode)
3839
{
3840
  init_call_opcodes ();
3841
  return (opcode == call0_op
3842
          || opcode == call4_op
3843
          || opcode == call8_op
3844
          || opcode == call12_op);
3845
}
3846
 
3847
 
3848
static bfd_boolean
3849
is_windowed_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode opcode)
3850
{
3851
  init_call_opcodes ();
3852
  return (opcode == call4_op
3853
          || opcode == call8_op
3854
          || opcode == call12_op
3855
          || opcode == callx4_op
3856
          || opcode == callx8_op
3857
          || opcode == callx12_op);
3858
}
3859
 
3860
 
3861
static bfd_boolean
3862
get_indirect_call_dest_reg (xtensa_opcode opcode, unsigned *pdst)
3863
{
3864
  unsigned dst = (unsigned) -1;
3865
 
3866
  init_call_opcodes ();
3867
  if (opcode == callx0_op)
3868
    dst = 0;
3869
  else if (opcode == callx4_op)
3870
    dst = 4;
3871
  else if (opcode == callx8_op)
3872
    dst = 8;
3873
  else if (opcode == callx12_op)
3874
    dst = 12;
3875
 
3876
  if (dst == (unsigned) -1)
3877
    return FALSE;
3878
 
3879
  *pdst = dst;
3880
  return TRUE;
3881
}
3882
 
3883
 
3884
static xtensa_opcode
3885
get_const16_opcode (void)
3886
{
3887
  static bfd_boolean done_lookup = FALSE;
3888
  static xtensa_opcode const16_opcode = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3889
  if (!done_lookup)
3890
    {
3891
      const16_opcode = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "const16");
3892
      done_lookup = TRUE;
3893
    }
3894
  return const16_opcode;
3895
}
3896
 
3897
 
3898
static xtensa_opcode
3899
get_l32r_opcode (void)
3900
{
3901
  static xtensa_opcode l32r_opcode = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3902
  static bfd_boolean done_lookup = FALSE;
3903
 
3904
  if (!done_lookup)
3905
    {
3906
      l32r_opcode = xtensa_opcode_lookup (xtensa_default_isa, "l32r");
3907
      done_lookup = TRUE;
3908
    }
3909
  return l32r_opcode;
3910
}
3911
 
3912
 
3913
static bfd_vma
3914
l32r_offset (bfd_vma addr, bfd_vma pc)
3915
{
3916
  bfd_vma offset;
3917
 
3918
  offset = addr - ((pc+3) & -4);
3919
  BFD_ASSERT ((offset & ((1 << 2) - 1)) == 0);
3920
  offset = (signed int) offset >> 2;
3921
  BFD_ASSERT ((signed int) offset >> 16 == -1);
3922
  return offset;
3923
}
3924
 
3925
 
3926
static int
3927
get_relocation_opnd (xtensa_opcode opcode, int r_type)
3928
{
3929
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
3930
  int last_immed, last_opnd, opi;
3931
 
3932
  if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
3933
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3934
 
3935
  /* Find the last visible PC-relative immediate operand for the opcode.
3936
     If there are no PC-relative immediates, then choose the last visible
3937
     immediate; otherwise, fail and return XTENSA_UNDEFINED.  */
3938
  last_immed = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3939
  last_opnd = xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, opcode);
3940
  for (opi = last_opnd - 1; opi >= 0; opi--)
3941
    {
3942
      if (xtensa_operand_is_visible (isa, opcode, opi) == 0)
3943
        continue;
3944
      if (xtensa_operand_is_PCrelative (isa, opcode, opi) == 1)
3945
        {
3946
          last_immed = opi;
3947
          break;
3948
        }
3949
      if (last_immed == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
3950
          && xtensa_operand_is_register (isa, opcode, opi) == 0)
3951
        last_immed = opi;
3952
    }
3953
  if (last_immed < 0)
3954
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3955
 
3956
  /* If the operand number was specified in an old-style relocation,
3957
     check for consistency with the operand computed above.  */
3958
  if (r_type >= R_XTENSA_OP0 && r_type <= R_XTENSA_OP2)
3959
    {
3960
      int reloc_opnd = r_type - R_XTENSA_OP0;
3961
      if (reloc_opnd != last_immed)
3962
        return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3963
    }
3964
 
3965
  return last_immed;
3966
}
3967
 
3968
 
3969
int
3970
get_relocation_slot (int r_type)
3971
{
3972
  switch (r_type)
3973
    {
3974
    case R_XTENSA_OP0:
3975
    case R_XTENSA_OP1:
3976
    case R_XTENSA_OP2:
3977
      return 0;
3978
 
3979
    default:
3980
      if (r_type >= R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP && r_type <= R_XTENSA_SLOT14_OP)
3981
        return r_type - R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP;
3982
      if (r_type >= R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT && r_type <= R_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT)
3983
        return r_type - R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT;
3984
      break;
3985
    }
3986
 
3987
  return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
3988
}
3989
 
3990
 
3991
/* Get the opcode for a relocation.  */
3992
 
3993
static xtensa_opcode
3994
get_relocation_opcode (bfd *abfd,
3995
                       asection *sec,
3996
                       bfd_byte *contents,
3997
                       Elf_Internal_Rela *irel)
3998
{
3999
  static xtensa_insnbuf ibuff = NULL;
4000
  static xtensa_insnbuf sbuff = NULL;
4001
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4002
  xtensa_format fmt;
4003
  int slot;
4004
 
4005
  if (contents == NULL)
4006
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4007
 
4008
  if (bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec) <= irel->r_offset)
4009
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4010
 
4011
  if (ibuff == NULL)
4012
    {
4013
      ibuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4014
      sbuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4015
    }
4016
 
4017
  /* Decode the instruction.  */
4018
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, ibuff, &contents[irel->r_offset],
4019
                             sec->size - irel->r_offset);
4020
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, ibuff);
4021
  slot = get_relocation_slot (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info));
4022
  if (slot == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4023
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4024
  xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, slot, ibuff, sbuff);
4025
  return xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, slot, sbuff);
4026
}
4027
 
4028
 
4029
bfd_boolean
4030
is_l32r_relocation (bfd *abfd,
4031
                    asection *sec,
4032
                    bfd_byte *contents,
4033
                    Elf_Internal_Rela *irel)
4034
{
4035
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
4036
  if (!is_operand_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
4037
    return FALSE;
4038
  opcode = get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
4039
  return (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ());
4040
}
4041
 
4042
 
4043
static bfd_size_type
4044
get_asm_simplify_size (bfd_byte *contents,
4045
                       bfd_size_type content_len,
4046
                       bfd_size_type offset)
4047
{
4048
  bfd_size_type insnlen, size = 0;
4049
 
4050
  /* Decode the size of the next two instructions.  */
4051
  insnlen = insn_decode_len (contents, content_len, offset);
4052
  if (insnlen == 0)
4053
    return 0;
4054
 
4055
  size += insnlen;
4056
 
4057
  insnlen = insn_decode_len (contents, content_len, offset + size);
4058
  if (insnlen == 0)
4059
    return 0;
4060
 
4061
  size += insnlen;
4062
  return size;
4063
}
4064
 
4065
 
4066
bfd_boolean
4067
is_alt_relocation (int r_type)
4068
{
4069
  return (r_type >= R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT
4070
          && r_type <= R_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT);
4071
}
4072
 
4073
 
4074
bfd_boolean
4075
is_operand_relocation (int r_type)
4076
{
4077
  switch (r_type)
4078
    {
4079
    case R_XTENSA_OP0:
4080
    case R_XTENSA_OP1:
4081
    case R_XTENSA_OP2:
4082
      return TRUE;
4083
 
4084
    default:
4085
      if (r_type >= R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP && r_type <= R_XTENSA_SLOT14_OP)
4086
        return TRUE;
4087
      if (r_type >= R_XTENSA_SLOT0_ALT && r_type <= R_XTENSA_SLOT14_ALT)
4088
        return TRUE;
4089
      break;
4090
    }
4091
 
4092
  return FALSE;
4093
}
4094
 
4095
 
4096
#define MIN_INSN_LENGTH 2
4097
 
4098
/* Return 0 if it fails to decode.  */
4099
 
4100
bfd_size_type
4101
insn_decode_len (bfd_byte *contents,
4102
                 bfd_size_type content_len,
4103
                 bfd_size_type offset)
4104
{
4105
  int insn_len;
4106
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4107
  xtensa_format fmt;
4108
  static xtensa_insnbuf ibuff = NULL;
4109
 
4110
  if (offset + MIN_INSN_LENGTH > content_len)
4111
    return 0;
4112
 
4113
  if (ibuff == NULL)
4114
    ibuff = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4115
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, ibuff, &contents[offset],
4116
                             content_len - offset);
4117
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, ibuff);
4118
  if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4119
    return 0;
4120
  insn_len = xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4121
  if (insn_len ==  XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4122
    return 0;
4123
  return insn_len;
4124
}
4125
 
4126
 
4127
/* Decode the opcode for a single slot instruction.
4128
   Return 0 if it fails to decode or the instruction is multi-slot.  */
4129
 
4130
xtensa_opcode
4131
insn_decode_opcode (bfd_byte *contents,
4132
                    bfd_size_type content_len,
4133
                    bfd_size_type offset,
4134
                    int slot)
4135
{
4136
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4137
  xtensa_format fmt;
4138
  static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
4139
  static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
4140
 
4141
  if (offset + MIN_INSN_LENGTH > content_len)
4142
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4143
 
4144
  if (insnbuf == NULL)
4145
    {
4146
      insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4147
      slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4148
    }
4149
 
4150
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, &contents[offset],
4151
                             content_len - offset);
4152
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4153
  if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4154
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4155
 
4156
  if (slot >= xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt))
4157
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4158
 
4159
  xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, slot, insnbuf, slotbuf);
4160
  return xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, slot, slotbuf);
4161
}
4162
 
4163
 
4164
/* The offset is the offset in the contents.
4165
   The address is the address of that offset.  */
4166
 
4167
static bfd_boolean
4168
check_branch_target_aligned (bfd_byte *contents,
4169
                             bfd_size_type content_length,
4170
                             bfd_vma offset,
4171
                             bfd_vma address)
4172
{
4173
  bfd_size_type insn_len = insn_decode_len (contents, content_length, offset);
4174
  if (insn_len == 0)
4175
    return FALSE;
4176
  return check_branch_target_aligned_address (address, insn_len);
4177
}
4178
 
4179
 
4180
static bfd_boolean
4181
check_loop_aligned (bfd_byte *contents,
4182
                    bfd_size_type content_length,
4183
                    bfd_vma offset,
4184
                    bfd_vma address)
4185
{
4186
  bfd_size_type loop_len, insn_len;
4187
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
4188
 
4189
  opcode = insn_decode_opcode (contents, content_length, offset, 0);
4190
  if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4191
      || xtensa_opcode_is_loop (xtensa_default_isa, opcode) != 1)
4192
    {
4193
      BFD_ASSERT (FALSE);
4194
      return FALSE;
4195
    }
4196
 
4197
  loop_len = insn_decode_len (contents, content_length, offset);
4198
  insn_len = insn_decode_len (contents, content_length, offset + loop_len);
4199
  if (loop_len == 0 || insn_len == 0)
4200
    {
4201
      BFD_ASSERT (FALSE);
4202
      return FALSE;
4203
    }
4204
 
4205
  return check_branch_target_aligned_address (address + loop_len, insn_len);
4206
}
4207
 
4208
 
4209
static bfd_boolean
4210
check_branch_target_aligned_address (bfd_vma addr, int len)
4211
{
4212
  if (len == 8)
4213
    return (addr % 8 == 0);
4214
  return ((addr >> 2) == ((addr + len - 1) >> 2));
4215
}
4216
 
4217
 
4218
/* Instruction widening and narrowing.  */
4219
 
4220
/* When FLIX is available we need to access certain instructions only
4221
   when they are 16-bit or 24-bit instructions.  This table caches
4222
   information about such instructions by walking through all the
4223
   opcodes and finding the smallest single-slot format into which each
4224
   can be encoded.  */
4225
 
4226
static xtensa_format *op_single_fmt_table = NULL;
4227
 
4228
 
4229
static void
4230
init_op_single_format_table (void)
4231
{
4232
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4233
  xtensa_insnbuf ibuf;
4234
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
4235
  xtensa_format fmt;
4236
  int num_opcodes;
4237
 
4238
  if (op_single_fmt_table)
4239
    return;
4240
 
4241
  ibuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4242
  num_opcodes = xtensa_isa_num_opcodes (isa);
4243
 
4244
  op_single_fmt_table = (xtensa_format *)
4245
    bfd_malloc (sizeof (xtensa_format) * num_opcodes);
4246
  for (opcode = 0; opcode < num_opcodes; opcode++)
4247
    {
4248
      op_single_fmt_table[opcode] = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4249
      for (fmt = 0; fmt < xtensa_isa_num_formats (isa); fmt++)
4250
        {
4251
          if (xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt) == 1
4252
              && xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, fmt, 0, ibuf, opcode) == 0)
4253
            {
4254
              xtensa_opcode old_fmt = op_single_fmt_table[opcode];
4255
              int fmt_length = xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4256
              if (old_fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4257
                  || fmt_length < xtensa_format_length (isa, old_fmt))
4258
                op_single_fmt_table[opcode] = fmt;
4259
            }
4260
        }
4261
    }
4262
  xtensa_insnbuf_free (isa, ibuf);
4263
}
4264
 
4265
 
4266
static xtensa_format
4267
get_single_format (xtensa_opcode opcode)
4268
{
4269
  init_op_single_format_table ();
4270
  return op_single_fmt_table[opcode];
4271
}
4272
 
4273
 
4274
/* For the set of narrowable instructions we do NOT include the
4275
   narrowings beqz -> beqz.n or bnez -> bnez.n because of complexities
4276
   involved during linker relaxation that may require these to
4277
   re-expand in some conditions.  Also, the narrowing "or" -> mov.n
4278
   requires special case code to ensure it only works when op1 == op2.  */
4279
 
4280
struct string_pair
4281
{
4282
  const char *wide;
4283
  const char *narrow;
4284
};
4285
 
4286
struct string_pair narrowable[] =
4287
{
4288
  { "add", "add.n" },
4289
  { "addi", "addi.n" },
4290
  { "addmi", "addi.n" },
4291
  { "l32i", "l32i.n" },
4292
  { "movi", "movi.n" },
4293
  { "ret", "ret.n" },
4294
  { "retw", "retw.n" },
4295
  { "s32i", "s32i.n" },
4296
  { "or", "mov.n" } /* special case only when op1 == op2 */
4297
};
4298
 
4299
struct string_pair widenable[] =
4300
{
4301
  { "add", "add.n" },
4302
  { "addi", "addi.n" },
4303
  { "addmi", "addi.n" },
4304
  { "beqz", "beqz.n" },
4305
  { "bnez", "bnez.n" },
4306
  { "l32i", "l32i.n" },
4307
  { "movi", "movi.n" },
4308
  { "ret", "ret.n" },
4309
  { "retw", "retw.n" },
4310
  { "s32i", "s32i.n" },
4311
  { "or", "mov.n" } /* special case only when op1 == op2 */
4312
};
4313
 
4314
 
4315
/* Check if an instruction can be "narrowed", i.e., changed from a standard
4316
   3-byte instruction to a 2-byte "density" instruction.  If it is valid,
4317
   return the instruction buffer holding the narrow instruction.  Otherwise,
4318
   return 0.  The set of valid narrowing are specified by a string table
4319
   but require some special case operand checks in some cases.  */
4320
 
4321
static xtensa_insnbuf
4322
can_narrow_instruction (xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf,
4323
                        xtensa_format fmt,
4324
                        xtensa_opcode opcode)
4325
{
4326
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4327
  xtensa_format o_fmt;
4328
  unsigned opi;
4329
 
4330
  static xtensa_insnbuf o_insnbuf = NULL;
4331
  static xtensa_insnbuf o_slotbuf = NULL;
4332
 
4333
  if (o_insnbuf == NULL)
4334
    {
4335
      o_insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4336
      o_slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4337
    }
4338
 
4339
  for (opi = 0; opi < (sizeof (narrowable)/sizeof (struct string_pair)); opi++)
4340
    {
4341
      bfd_boolean is_or = (strcmp ("or", narrowable[opi].wide) == 0);
4342
 
4343
      if (opcode == xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, narrowable[opi].wide))
4344
        {
4345
          uint32 value, newval;
4346
          int i, operand_count, o_operand_count;
4347
          xtensa_opcode o_opcode;
4348
 
4349
          /* Address does not matter in this case.  We might need to
4350
             fix it to handle branches/jumps.  */
4351
          bfd_vma self_address = 0;
4352
 
4353
          o_opcode = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, narrowable[opi].narrow);
4354
          if (o_opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4355
            return 0;
4356
          o_fmt = get_single_format (o_opcode);
4357
          if (o_fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4358
            return 0;
4359
 
4360
          if (xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt) != 3
4361
              || xtensa_format_length (isa, o_fmt) != 2)
4362
            return 0;
4363
 
4364
          xtensa_format_encode (isa, o_fmt, o_insnbuf);
4365
          operand_count = xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, opcode);
4366
          o_operand_count = xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, o_opcode);
4367
 
4368
          if (xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, o_fmt, 0, o_slotbuf, o_opcode) != 0)
4369
            return 0;
4370
 
4371
          if (!is_or)
4372
            {
4373
              if (xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, o_opcode) != operand_count)
4374
                return 0;
4375
            }
4376
          else
4377
            {
4378
              uint32 rawval0, rawval1, rawval2;
4379
 
4380
              if (o_operand_count + 1 != operand_count
4381
                  || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, 0,
4382
                                               fmt, 0, slotbuf, &rawval0) != 0
4383
                  || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, 1,
4384
                                               fmt, 0, slotbuf, &rawval1) != 0
4385
                  || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, 2,
4386
                                               fmt, 0, slotbuf, &rawval2) != 0
4387
                  || rawval1 != rawval2
4388
                  || rawval0 == rawval1 /* it is a nop */)
4389
                return 0;
4390
            }
4391
 
4392
          for (i = 0; i < o_operand_count; ++i)
4393
            {
4394
              if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, i, fmt, 0,
4395
                                            slotbuf, &value)
4396
                  || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, i, &value))
4397
                return 0;
4398
 
4399
              /* PC-relative branches need adjustment, but
4400
                 the PC-rel operand will always have a relocation.  */
4401
              newval = value;
4402
              if (xtensa_operand_do_reloc (isa, o_opcode, i, &newval,
4403
                                           self_address)
4404
                  || xtensa_operand_encode (isa, o_opcode, i, &newval)
4405
                  || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, o_opcode, i, o_fmt, 0,
4406
                                               o_slotbuf, newval))
4407
                return 0;
4408
            }
4409
 
4410
          if (xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, o_fmt, 0, o_insnbuf, o_slotbuf))
4411
            return 0;
4412
 
4413
          return o_insnbuf;
4414
        }
4415
    }
4416
  return 0;
4417
}
4418
 
4419
 
4420
/* Attempt to narrow an instruction.  If the narrowing is valid, perform
4421
   the action in-place directly into the contents and return TRUE.  Otherwise,
4422
   the return value is FALSE and the contents are not modified.  */
4423
 
4424
static bfd_boolean
4425
narrow_instruction (bfd_byte *contents,
4426
                    bfd_size_type content_length,
4427
                    bfd_size_type offset)
4428
{
4429
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
4430
  bfd_size_type insn_len;
4431
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4432
  xtensa_format fmt;
4433
  xtensa_insnbuf o_insnbuf;
4434
 
4435
  static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
4436
  static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
4437
 
4438
  if (insnbuf == NULL)
4439
    {
4440
      insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4441
      slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4442
    }
4443
 
4444
  BFD_ASSERT (offset < content_length);
4445
 
4446
  if (content_length < 2)
4447
    return FALSE;
4448
 
4449
  /* We will hand-code a few of these for a little while.
4450
     These have all been specified in the assembler aleady.  */
4451
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, &contents[offset],
4452
                             content_length - offset);
4453
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4454
  if (xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt) != 1)
4455
    return FALSE;
4456
 
4457
  if (xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf) != 0)
4458
    return FALSE;
4459
 
4460
  opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
4461
  if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4462
    return FALSE;
4463
  insn_len = xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4464
  if (insn_len > content_length)
4465
    return FALSE;
4466
 
4467
  o_insnbuf = can_narrow_instruction (slotbuf, fmt, opcode);
4468
  if (o_insnbuf)
4469
    {
4470
      xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, o_insnbuf, contents + offset,
4471
                               content_length - offset);
4472
      return TRUE;
4473
    }
4474
 
4475
  return FALSE;
4476
}
4477
 
4478
 
4479
/* Check if an instruction can be "widened", i.e., changed from a 2-byte
4480
   "density" instruction to a standard 3-byte instruction.  If it is valid,
4481
   return the instruction buffer holding the wide instruction.  Otherwise,
4482
   return 0.  The set of valid widenings are specified by a string table
4483
   but require some special case operand checks in some cases.  */
4484
 
4485
static xtensa_insnbuf
4486
can_widen_instruction (xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf,
4487
                       xtensa_format fmt,
4488
                       xtensa_opcode opcode)
4489
{
4490
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4491
  xtensa_format o_fmt;
4492
  unsigned opi;
4493
 
4494
  static xtensa_insnbuf o_insnbuf = NULL;
4495
  static xtensa_insnbuf o_slotbuf = NULL;
4496
 
4497
  if (o_insnbuf == NULL)
4498
    {
4499
      o_insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4500
      o_slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4501
    }
4502
 
4503
  for (opi = 0; opi < (sizeof (widenable)/sizeof (struct string_pair)); opi++)
4504
    {
4505
      bfd_boolean is_or = (strcmp ("or", widenable[opi].wide) == 0);
4506
      bfd_boolean is_branch = (strcmp ("beqz", widenable[opi].wide) == 0
4507
                               || strcmp ("bnez", widenable[opi].wide) == 0);
4508
 
4509
      if (opcode == xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, widenable[opi].narrow))
4510
        {
4511
          uint32 value, newval;
4512
          int i, operand_count, o_operand_count, check_operand_count;
4513
          xtensa_opcode o_opcode;
4514
 
4515
          /* Address does not matter in this case.  We might need to fix it
4516
             to handle branches/jumps.  */
4517
          bfd_vma self_address = 0;
4518
 
4519
          o_opcode = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, widenable[opi].wide);
4520
          if (o_opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4521
            return 0;
4522
          o_fmt = get_single_format (o_opcode);
4523
          if (o_fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4524
            return 0;
4525
 
4526
          if (xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt) != 2
4527
              || xtensa_format_length (isa, o_fmt) != 3)
4528
            return 0;
4529
 
4530
          xtensa_format_encode (isa, o_fmt, o_insnbuf);
4531
          operand_count = xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, opcode);
4532
          o_operand_count = xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, o_opcode);
4533
          check_operand_count = o_operand_count;
4534
 
4535
          if (xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, o_fmt, 0, o_slotbuf, o_opcode) != 0)
4536
            return 0;
4537
 
4538
          if (!is_or)
4539
            {
4540
              if (xtensa_opcode_num_operands (isa, o_opcode) != operand_count)
4541
                return 0;
4542
            }
4543
          else
4544
            {
4545
              uint32 rawval0, rawval1;
4546
 
4547
              if (o_operand_count != operand_count + 1
4548
                  || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, 0,
4549
                                               fmt, 0, slotbuf, &rawval0) != 0
4550
                  || xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, 1,
4551
                                               fmt, 0, slotbuf, &rawval1) != 0
4552
                  || rawval0 == rawval1 /* it is a nop */)
4553
                return 0;
4554
            }
4555
          if (is_branch)
4556
            check_operand_count--;
4557
 
4558
          for (i = 0; i < check_operand_count; i++)
4559
            {
4560
              int new_i = i;
4561
              if (is_or && i == o_operand_count - 1)
4562
                new_i = i - 1;
4563
              if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, new_i, fmt, 0,
4564
                                            slotbuf, &value)
4565
                  || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, new_i, &value))
4566
                return 0;
4567
 
4568
              /* PC-relative branches need adjustment, but
4569
                 the PC-rel operand will always have a relocation.  */
4570
              newval = value;
4571
              if (xtensa_operand_do_reloc (isa, o_opcode, i, &newval,
4572
                                           self_address)
4573
                  || xtensa_operand_encode (isa, o_opcode, i, &newval)
4574
                  || xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, o_opcode, i, o_fmt, 0,
4575
                                               o_slotbuf, newval))
4576
                return 0;
4577
            }
4578
 
4579
          if (xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, o_fmt, 0, o_insnbuf, o_slotbuf))
4580
            return 0;
4581
 
4582
          return o_insnbuf;
4583
        }
4584
    }
4585
  return 0;
4586
}
4587
 
4588
 
4589
/* Attempt to widen an instruction.  If the widening is valid, perform
4590
   the action in-place directly into the contents and return TRUE.  Otherwise,
4591
   the return value is FALSE and the contents are not modified.  */
4592
 
4593
static bfd_boolean
4594
widen_instruction (bfd_byte *contents,
4595
                   bfd_size_type content_length,
4596
                   bfd_size_type offset)
4597
{
4598
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
4599
  bfd_size_type insn_len;
4600
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4601
  xtensa_format fmt;
4602
  xtensa_insnbuf o_insnbuf;
4603
 
4604
  static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
4605
  static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
4606
 
4607
  if (insnbuf == NULL)
4608
    {
4609
      insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4610
      slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4611
    }
4612
 
4613
  BFD_ASSERT (offset < content_length);
4614
 
4615
  if (content_length < 2)
4616
    return FALSE;
4617
 
4618
  /* We will hand-code a few of these for a little while.
4619
     These have all been specified in the assembler aleady.  */
4620
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, &contents[offset],
4621
                             content_length - offset);
4622
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4623
  if (xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt) != 1)
4624
    return FALSE;
4625
 
4626
  if (xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf) != 0)
4627
    return FALSE;
4628
 
4629
  opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
4630
  if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4631
    return FALSE;
4632
  insn_len = xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4633
  if (insn_len > content_length)
4634
    return FALSE;
4635
 
4636
  o_insnbuf = can_widen_instruction (slotbuf, fmt, opcode);
4637
  if (o_insnbuf)
4638
    {
4639
      xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, o_insnbuf, contents + offset,
4640
                               content_length - offset);
4641
      return TRUE;
4642
    }
4643
  return FALSE;
4644
}
4645
 
4646
 
4647
/* Code for transforming CALLs at link-time.  */
4648
 
4649
static bfd_reloc_status_type
4650
elf_xtensa_do_asm_simplify (bfd_byte *contents,
4651
                            bfd_vma address,
4652
                            bfd_vma content_length,
4653
                            char **error_message)
4654
{
4655
  static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
4656
  static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
4657
  xtensa_format core_format = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4658
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
4659
  xtensa_opcode direct_call_opcode;
4660
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4661
  bfd_byte *chbuf = contents + address;
4662
  int opn;
4663
 
4664
  if (insnbuf == NULL)
4665
    {
4666
      insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4667
      slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4668
    }
4669
 
4670
  if (content_length < address)
4671
    {
4672
      *error_message = _("Attempt to convert L32R/CALLX to CALL failed");
4673
      return bfd_reloc_other;
4674
    }
4675
 
4676
  opcode = get_expanded_call_opcode (chbuf, content_length - address, 0);
4677
  direct_call_opcode = swap_callx_for_call_opcode (opcode);
4678
  if (direct_call_opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4679
    {
4680
      *error_message = _("Attempt to convert L32R/CALLX to CALL failed");
4681
      return bfd_reloc_other;
4682
    }
4683
 
4684
  /* Assemble a NOP ("or a1, a1, a1") into the 0 byte offset.  */
4685
  core_format = xtensa_format_lookup (isa, "x24");
4686
  opcode = xtensa_opcode_lookup (isa, "or");
4687
  xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, core_format, 0, slotbuf, opcode);
4688
  for (opn = 0; opn < 3; opn++)
4689
    {
4690
      uint32 regno = 1;
4691
      xtensa_operand_encode (isa, opcode, opn, &regno);
4692
      xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, opcode, opn, core_format, 0,
4693
                                slotbuf, regno);
4694
    }
4695
  xtensa_format_encode (isa, core_format, insnbuf);
4696
  xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, core_format, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf);
4697
  xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, insnbuf, chbuf, content_length - address);
4698
 
4699
  /* Assemble a CALL ("callN 0") into the 3 byte offset.  */
4700
  xtensa_opcode_encode (isa, core_format, 0, slotbuf, direct_call_opcode);
4701
  xtensa_operand_set_field (isa, opcode, 0, core_format, 0, slotbuf, 0);
4702
 
4703
  xtensa_format_encode (isa, core_format, insnbuf);
4704
  xtensa_format_set_slot (isa, core_format, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf);
4705
  xtensa_insnbuf_to_chars (isa, insnbuf, chbuf + 3,
4706
                           content_length - address - 3);
4707
 
4708
  return bfd_reloc_ok;
4709
}
4710
 
4711
 
4712
static bfd_reloc_status_type
4713
contract_asm_expansion (bfd_byte *contents,
4714
                        bfd_vma content_length,
4715
                        Elf_Internal_Rela *irel,
4716
                        char **error_message)
4717
{
4718
  bfd_reloc_status_type retval =
4719
    elf_xtensa_do_asm_simplify (contents, irel->r_offset, content_length,
4720
                                error_message);
4721
 
4722
  if (retval != bfd_reloc_ok)
4723
    return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
4724
 
4725
  /* Update the irel->r_offset field so that the right immediate and
4726
     the right instruction are modified during the relocation.  */
4727
  irel->r_offset += 3;
4728
  irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), R_XTENSA_SLOT0_OP);
4729
  return bfd_reloc_ok;
4730
}
4731
 
4732
 
4733
static xtensa_opcode
4734
swap_callx_for_call_opcode (xtensa_opcode opcode)
4735
{
4736
  init_call_opcodes ();
4737
 
4738
  if (opcode == callx0_op) return call0_op;
4739
  if (opcode == callx4_op) return call4_op;
4740
  if (opcode == callx8_op) return call8_op;
4741
  if (opcode == callx12_op) return call12_op;
4742
 
4743
  /* Return XTENSA_UNDEFINED if the opcode is not an indirect call.  */
4744
  return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4745
}
4746
 
4747
 
4748
/* Check if "buf" is pointing to a "L32R aN; CALLX aN" or "CONST16 aN;
4749
   CONST16 aN; CALLX aN" sequence, and if so, return the CALLX opcode.
4750
   If not, return XTENSA_UNDEFINED.  */
4751
 
4752
#define L32R_TARGET_REG_OPERAND 0
4753
#define CONST16_TARGET_REG_OPERAND 0
4754
#define CALLN_SOURCE_OPERAND 0
4755
 
4756
static xtensa_opcode
4757
get_expanded_call_opcode (bfd_byte *buf, int bufsize, bfd_boolean *p_uses_l32r)
4758
{
4759
  static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
4760
  static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
4761
  xtensa_format fmt;
4762
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
4763
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
4764
  uint32 regno, const16_regno, call_regno;
4765
  int offset = 0;
4766
 
4767
  if (insnbuf == NULL)
4768
    {
4769
      insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4770
      slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
4771
    }
4772
 
4773
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, buf, bufsize);
4774
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4775
  if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4776
      || xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf))
4777
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4778
 
4779
  opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
4780
  if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
4781
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4782
 
4783
  if (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ())
4784
    {
4785
      if (p_uses_l32r)
4786
        *p_uses_l32r = TRUE;
4787
      if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, L32R_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4788
                                    fmt, 0, slotbuf, &regno)
4789
          || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, L32R_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4790
                                    &regno))
4791
        return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4792
    }
4793
  else if (opcode == get_const16_opcode ())
4794
    {
4795
      if (p_uses_l32r)
4796
        *p_uses_l32r = FALSE;
4797
      if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, CONST16_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4798
                                    fmt, 0, slotbuf, &regno)
4799
          || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, CONST16_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4800
                                    &regno))
4801
        return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4802
 
4803
      /* Check that the next instruction is also CONST16.  */
4804
      offset += xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4805
      xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, buf + offset, bufsize - offset);
4806
      fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4807
      if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4808
          || xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf))
4809
        return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4810
      opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
4811
      if (opcode != get_const16_opcode ())
4812
        return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4813
 
4814
      if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, CONST16_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4815
                                    fmt, 0, slotbuf, &const16_regno)
4816
          || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, CONST16_TARGET_REG_OPERAND,
4817
                                    &const16_regno)
4818
          || const16_regno != regno)
4819
        return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4820
    }
4821
  else
4822
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4823
 
4824
  /* Next instruction should be an CALLXn with operand 0 == regno.  */
4825
  offset += xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
4826
  xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, buf + offset, bufsize - offset);
4827
  fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
4828
  if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4829
      || xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf))
4830
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4831
  opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
4832
  if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED
4833
      || !is_indirect_call_opcode (opcode))
4834
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4835
 
4836
  if (xtensa_operand_get_field (isa, opcode, CALLN_SOURCE_OPERAND,
4837
                                fmt, 0, slotbuf, &call_regno)
4838
      || xtensa_operand_decode (isa, opcode, CALLN_SOURCE_OPERAND,
4839
                                &call_regno))
4840
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4841
 
4842
  if (call_regno != regno)
4843
    return XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
4844
 
4845
  return opcode;
4846
}
4847
 
4848
 
4849
/* Data structures used during relaxation.  */
4850
 
4851
/* r_reloc: relocation values.  */
4852
 
4853
/* Through the relaxation process, we need to keep track of the values
4854
   that will result from evaluating relocations.  The standard ELF
4855
   relocation structure is not sufficient for this purpose because we're
4856
   operating on multiple input files at once, so we need to know which
4857
   input file a relocation refers to.  The r_reloc structure thus
4858
   records both the input file (bfd) and ELF relocation.
4859
 
4860
   For efficiency, an r_reloc also contains a "target_offset" field to
4861
   cache the target-section-relative offset value that is represented by
4862
   the relocation.
4863
 
4864
   The r_reloc also contains a virtual offset that allows multiple
4865
   inserted literals to be placed at the same "address" with
4866
   different offsets.  */
4867
 
4868
typedef struct r_reloc_struct r_reloc;
4869
 
4870
struct r_reloc_struct
4871
{
4872
  bfd *abfd;
4873
  Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
4874
  bfd_vma target_offset;
4875
  bfd_vma virtual_offset;
4876
};
4877
 
4878
 
4879
/* The r_reloc structure is included by value in literal_value, but not
4880
   every literal_value has an associated relocation -- some are simple
4881
   constants.  In such cases, we set all the fields in the r_reloc
4882
   struct to zero.  The r_reloc_is_const function should be used to
4883
   detect this case.  */
4884
 
4885
static bfd_boolean
4886
r_reloc_is_const (const r_reloc *r_rel)
4887
{
4888
  return (r_rel->abfd == NULL);
4889
}
4890
 
4891
 
4892
static bfd_vma
4893
r_reloc_get_target_offset (const r_reloc *r_rel)
4894
{
4895
  bfd_vma target_offset;
4896
  unsigned long r_symndx;
4897
 
4898
  BFD_ASSERT (!r_reloc_is_const (r_rel));
4899
  r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (r_rel->rela.r_info);
4900
  target_offset = get_elf_r_symndx_offset (r_rel->abfd, r_symndx);
4901
  return (target_offset + r_rel->rela.r_addend);
4902
}
4903
 
4904
 
4905
static struct elf_link_hash_entry *
4906
r_reloc_get_hash_entry (const r_reloc *r_rel)
4907
{
4908
  unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (r_rel->rela.r_info);
4909
  return get_elf_r_symndx_hash_entry (r_rel->abfd, r_symndx);
4910
}
4911
 
4912
 
4913
static asection *
4914
r_reloc_get_section (const r_reloc *r_rel)
4915
{
4916
  unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (r_rel->rela.r_info);
4917
  return get_elf_r_symndx_section (r_rel->abfd, r_symndx);
4918
}
4919
 
4920
 
4921
static bfd_boolean
4922
r_reloc_is_defined (const r_reloc *r_rel)
4923
{
4924
  asection *sec;
4925
  if (r_rel == NULL)
4926
    return FALSE;
4927
 
4928
  sec = r_reloc_get_section (r_rel);
4929
  if (sec == bfd_abs_section_ptr
4930
      || sec == bfd_com_section_ptr
4931
      || sec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
4932
    return FALSE;
4933
  return TRUE;
4934
}
4935
 
4936
 
4937
static void
4938
r_reloc_init (r_reloc *r_rel,
4939
              bfd *abfd,
4940
              Elf_Internal_Rela *irel,
4941
              bfd_byte *contents,
4942
              bfd_size_type content_length)
4943
{
4944
  int r_type;
4945
  reloc_howto_type *howto;
4946
 
4947
  if (irel)
4948
    {
4949
      r_rel->rela = *irel;
4950
      r_rel->abfd = abfd;
4951
      r_rel->target_offset = r_reloc_get_target_offset (r_rel);
4952
      r_rel->virtual_offset = 0;
4953
      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (r_rel->rela.r_info);
4954
      howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
4955
      if (howto->partial_inplace)
4956
        {
4957
          bfd_vma inplace_val;
4958
          BFD_ASSERT (r_rel->rela.r_offset < content_length);
4959
 
4960
          inplace_val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[r_rel->rela.r_offset]);
4961
          r_rel->target_offset += inplace_val;
4962
        }
4963
    }
4964
  else
4965
    memset (r_rel, 0, sizeof (r_reloc));
4966
}
4967
 
4968
 
4969
#if DEBUG
4970
 
4971
static void
4972
print_r_reloc (FILE *fp, const r_reloc *r_rel)
4973
{
4974
  if (r_reloc_is_defined (r_rel))
4975
    {
4976
      asection *sec = r_reloc_get_section (r_rel);
4977
      fprintf (fp, " %s(%s + ", sec->owner->filename, sec->name);
4978
    }
4979
  else if (r_reloc_get_hash_entry (r_rel))
4980
    fprintf (fp, " %s + ", r_reloc_get_hash_entry (r_rel)->root.root.string);
4981
  else
4982
    fprintf (fp, " ?? + ");
4983
 
4984
  fprintf_vma (fp, r_rel->target_offset);
4985
  if (r_rel->virtual_offset)
4986
    {
4987
      fprintf (fp, " + ");
4988
      fprintf_vma (fp, r_rel->virtual_offset);
4989
    }
4990
 
4991
  fprintf (fp, ")");
4992
}
4993
 
4994
#endif /* DEBUG */
4995
 
4996
 
4997
/* source_reloc: relocations that reference literals.  */
4998
 
4999
/* To determine whether literals can be coalesced, we need to first
5000
   record all the relocations that reference the literals.  The
5001
   source_reloc structure below is used for this purpose.  The
5002
   source_reloc entries are kept in a per-literal-section array, sorted
5003
   by offset within the literal section (i.e., target offset).
5004
 
5005
   The source_sec and r_rel.rela.r_offset fields identify the source of
5006
   the relocation.  The r_rel field records the relocation value, i.e.,
5007
   the offset of the literal being referenced.  The opnd field is needed
5008
   to determine the range of the immediate field to which the relocation
5009
   applies, so we can determine whether another literal with the same
5010
   value is within range.  The is_null field is true when the relocation
5011
   is being removed (e.g., when an L32R is being removed due to a CALLX
5012
   that is converted to a direct CALL).  */
5013
 
5014
typedef struct source_reloc_struct source_reloc;
5015
 
5016
struct source_reloc_struct
5017
{
5018
  asection *source_sec;
5019
  r_reloc r_rel;
5020
  xtensa_opcode opcode;
5021
  int opnd;
5022
  bfd_boolean is_null;
5023
  bfd_boolean is_abs_literal;
5024
};
5025
 
5026
 
5027
static void
5028
init_source_reloc (source_reloc *reloc,
5029
                   asection *source_sec,
5030
                   const r_reloc *r_rel,
5031
                   xtensa_opcode opcode,
5032
                   int opnd,
5033
                   bfd_boolean is_abs_literal)
5034
{
5035
  reloc->source_sec = source_sec;
5036
  reloc->r_rel = *r_rel;
5037
  reloc->opcode = opcode;
5038
  reloc->opnd = opnd;
5039
  reloc->is_null = FALSE;
5040
  reloc->is_abs_literal = is_abs_literal;
5041
}
5042
 
5043
 
5044
/* Find the source_reloc for a particular source offset and relocation
5045
   type.  Note that the array is sorted by _target_ offset, so this is
5046
   just a linear search.  */
5047
 
5048
static source_reloc *
5049
find_source_reloc (source_reloc *src_relocs,
5050
                   int src_count,
5051
                   asection *sec,
5052
                   Elf_Internal_Rela *irel)
5053
{
5054
  int i;
5055
 
5056
  for (i = 0; i < src_count; i++)
5057
    {
5058
      if (src_relocs[i].source_sec == sec
5059
          && src_relocs[i].r_rel.rela.r_offset == irel->r_offset
5060
          && (ELF32_R_TYPE (src_relocs[i].r_rel.rela.r_info)
5061
              == ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
5062
        return &src_relocs[i];
5063
    }
5064
 
5065
  return NULL;
5066
}
5067
 
5068
 
5069
static int
5070
source_reloc_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
5071
{
5072
  const source_reloc *a = (const source_reloc *) ap;
5073
  const source_reloc *b = (const source_reloc *) bp;
5074
 
5075
  if (a->r_rel.target_offset != b->r_rel.target_offset)
5076
    return (a->r_rel.target_offset - b->r_rel.target_offset);
5077
 
5078
  /* We don't need to sort on these criteria for correctness,
5079
     but enforcing a more strict ordering prevents unstable qsort
5080
     from behaving differently with different implementations.
5081
     Without the code below we get correct but different results
5082
     on Solaris 2.7 and 2.8.  We would like to always produce the
5083
     same results no matter the host. */
5084
 
5085
  if ((!a->is_null) - (!b->is_null))
5086
    return ((!a->is_null) - (!b->is_null));
5087
  return internal_reloc_compare (&a->r_rel.rela, &b->r_rel.rela);
5088
}
5089
 
5090
 
5091
/* Literal values and value hash tables.  */
5092
 
5093
/* Literals with the same value can be coalesced.  The literal_value
5094
   structure records the value of a literal: the "r_rel" field holds the
5095
   information from the relocation on the literal (if there is one) and
5096
   the "value" field holds the contents of the literal word itself.
5097
 
5098
   The value_map structure records a literal value along with the
5099
   location of a literal holding that value.  The value_map hash table
5100
   is indexed by the literal value, so that we can quickly check if a
5101
   particular literal value has been seen before and is thus a candidate
5102
   for coalescing.  */
5103
 
5104
typedef struct literal_value_struct literal_value;
5105
typedef struct value_map_struct value_map;
5106
typedef struct value_map_hash_table_struct value_map_hash_table;
5107
 
5108
struct literal_value_struct
5109
{
5110
  r_reloc r_rel;
5111
  unsigned long value;
5112
  bfd_boolean is_abs_literal;
5113
};
5114
 
5115
struct value_map_struct
5116
{
5117
  literal_value val;                    /* The literal value.  */
5118
  r_reloc loc;                          /* Location of the literal.  */
5119
  value_map *next;
5120
};
5121
 
5122
struct value_map_hash_table_struct
5123
{
5124
  unsigned bucket_count;
5125
  value_map **buckets;
5126
  unsigned count;
5127
  bfd_boolean has_last_loc;
5128
  r_reloc last_loc;
5129
};
5130
 
5131
 
5132
static void
5133
init_literal_value (literal_value *lit,
5134
                    const r_reloc *r_rel,
5135
                    unsigned long value,
5136
                    bfd_boolean is_abs_literal)
5137
{
5138
  lit->r_rel = *r_rel;
5139
  lit->value = value;
5140
  lit->is_abs_literal = is_abs_literal;
5141
}
5142
 
5143
 
5144
static bfd_boolean
5145
literal_value_equal (const literal_value *src1,
5146
                     const literal_value *src2,
5147
                     bfd_boolean final_static_link)
5148
{
5149
  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h1, *h2;
5150
 
5151
  if (r_reloc_is_const (&src1->r_rel) != r_reloc_is_const (&src2->r_rel))
5152
    return FALSE;
5153
 
5154
  if (r_reloc_is_const (&src1->r_rel))
5155
    return (src1->value == src2->value);
5156
 
5157
  if (ELF32_R_TYPE (src1->r_rel.rela.r_info)
5158
      != ELF32_R_TYPE (src2->r_rel.rela.r_info))
5159
    return FALSE;
5160
 
5161
  if (src1->r_rel.target_offset != src2->r_rel.target_offset)
5162
    return FALSE;
5163
 
5164
  if (src1->r_rel.virtual_offset != src2->r_rel.virtual_offset)
5165
    return FALSE;
5166
 
5167
  if (src1->value != src2->value)
5168
    return FALSE;
5169
 
5170
  /* Now check for the same section (if defined) or the same elf_hash
5171
     (if undefined or weak).  */
5172
  h1 = r_reloc_get_hash_entry (&src1->r_rel);
5173
  h2 = r_reloc_get_hash_entry (&src2->r_rel);
5174
  if (r_reloc_is_defined (&src1->r_rel)
5175
      && (final_static_link
5176
          || ((!h1 || h1->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5177
              && (!h2 || h2->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak))))
5178
    {
5179
      if (r_reloc_get_section (&src1->r_rel)
5180
          != r_reloc_get_section (&src2->r_rel))
5181
        return FALSE;
5182
    }
5183
  else
5184
    {
5185
      /* Require that the hash entries (i.e., symbols) be identical.  */
5186
      if (h1 != h2 || h1 == 0)
5187
        return FALSE;
5188
    }
5189
 
5190
  if (src1->is_abs_literal != src2->is_abs_literal)
5191
    return FALSE;
5192
 
5193
  return TRUE;
5194
}
5195
 
5196
 
5197
/* Must be power of 2.  */
5198
#define INITIAL_HASH_RELOC_BUCKET_COUNT 1024
5199
 
5200
static value_map_hash_table *
5201
value_map_hash_table_init (void)
5202
{
5203
  value_map_hash_table *values;
5204
 
5205
  values = (value_map_hash_table *)
5206
    bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (value_map_hash_table));
5207
  values->bucket_count = INITIAL_HASH_RELOC_BUCKET_COUNT;
5208
  values->count = 0;
5209
  values->buckets = (value_map **)
5210
    bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (value_map *) * values->bucket_count);
5211
  if (values->buckets == NULL)
5212
    {
5213
      free (values);
5214
      return NULL;
5215
    }
5216
  values->has_last_loc = FALSE;
5217
 
5218
  return values;
5219
}
5220
 
5221
 
5222
static void
5223
value_map_hash_table_delete (value_map_hash_table *table)
5224
{
5225
  free (table->buckets);
5226
  free (table);
5227
}
5228
 
5229
 
5230
static unsigned
5231
hash_bfd_vma (bfd_vma val)
5232
{
5233
  return (val >> 2) + (val >> 10);
5234
}
5235
 
5236
 
5237
static unsigned
5238
literal_value_hash (const literal_value *src)
5239
{
5240
  unsigned hash_val;
5241
 
5242
  hash_val = hash_bfd_vma (src->value);
5243
  if (!r_reloc_is_const (&src->r_rel))
5244
    {
5245
      void *sec_or_hash;
5246
 
5247
      hash_val += hash_bfd_vma (src->is_abs_literal * 1000);
5248
      hash_val += hash_bfd_vma (src->r_rel.target_offset);
5249
      hash_val += hash_bfd_vma (src->r_rel.virtual_offset);
5250
 
5251
      /* Now check for the same section and the same elf_hash.  */
5252
      if (r_reloc_is_defined (&src->r_rel))
5253
        sec_or_hash = r_reloc_get_section (&src->r_rel);
5254
      else
5255
        sec_or_hash = r_reloc_get_hash_entry (&src->r_rel);
5256
      hash_val += hash_bfd_vma ((bfd_vma) (size_t) sec_or_hash);
5257
    }
5258
  return hash_val;
5259
}
5260
 
5261
 
5262
/* Check if the specified literal_value has been seen before.  */
5263
 
5264
static value_map *
5265
value_map_get_cached_value (value_map_hash_table *map,
5266
                            const literal_value *val,
5267
                            bfd_boolean final_static_link)
5268
{
5269
  value_map *map_e;
5270
  value_map *bucket;
5271
  unsigned idx;
5272
 
5273
  idx = literal_value_hash (val);
5274
  idx = idx & (map->bucket_count - 1);
5275
  bucket = map->buckets[idx];
5276
  for (map_e = bucket; map_e; map_e = map_e->next)
5277
    {
5278
      if (literal_value_equal (&map_e->val, val, final_static_link))
5279
        return map_e;
5280
    }
5281
  return NULL;
5282
}
5283
 
5284
 
5285
/* Record a new literal value.  It is illegal to call this if VALUE
5286
   already has an entry here.  */
5287
 
5288
static value_map *
5289
add_value_map (value_map_hash_table *map,
5290
               const literal_value *val,
5291
               const r_reloc *loc,
5292
               bfd_boolean final_static_link)
5293
{
5294
  value_map **bucket_p;
5295
  unsigned idx;
5296
 
5297
  value_map *val_e = (value_map *) bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (value_map));
5298
  if (val_e == NULL)
5299
    {
5300
      bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
5301
      return NULL;
5302
    }
5303
 
5304
  BFD_ASSERT (!value_map_get_cached_value (map, val, final_static_link));
5305
  val_e->val = *val;
5306
  val_e->loc = *loc;
5307
 
5308
  idx = literal_value_hash (val);
5309
  idx = idx & (map->bucket_count - 1);
5310
  bucket_p = &map->buckets[idx];
5311
 
5312
  val_e->next = *bucket_p;
5313
  *bucket_p = val_e;
5314
  map->count++;
5315
  /* FIXME: Consider resizing the hash table if we get too many entries.  */
5316
 
5317
  return val_e;
5318
}
5319
 
5320
 
5321
/* Lists of text actions (ta_) for narrowing, widening, longcall
5322
   conversion, space fill, code & literal removal, etc.  */
5323
 
5324
/* The following text actions are generated:
5325
 
5326
   "ta_remove_insn"         remove an instruction or instructions
5327
   "ta_remove_longcall"     convert longcall to call
5328
   "ta_convert_longcall"    convert longcall to nop/call
5329
   "ta_narrow_insn"         narrow a wide instruction
5330
   "ta_widen"               widen a narrow instruction
5331
   "ta_fill"                add fill or remove fill
5332
      removed < 0 is a fill; branches to the fill address will be
5333
        changed to address + fill size (e.g., address - removed)
5334
      removed >= 0 branches to the fill address will stay unchanged
5335
   "ta_remove_literal"      remove a literal; this action is
5336
                            indicated when a literal is removed
5337
                            or replaced.
5338
   "ta_add_literal"         insert a new literal; this action is
5339
                            indicated when a literal has been moved.
5340
                            It may use a virtual_offset because
5341
                            multiple literals can be placed at the
5342
                            same location.
5343
 
5344
   For each of these text actions, we also record the number of bytes
5345
   removed by performing the text action.  In the case of a "ta_widen"
5346
   or a "ta_fill" that adds space, the removed_bytes will be negative.  */
5347
 
5348
typedef struct text_action_struct text_action;
5349
typedef struct text_action_list_struct text_action_list;
5350
typedef enum text_action_enum_t text_action_t;
5351
 
5352
enum text_action_enum_t
5353
{
5354
  ta_none,
5355
  ta_remove_insn,        /* removed = -size */
5356
  ta_remove_longcall,    /* removed = -size */
5357
  ta_convert_longcall,   /* removed = 0 */
5358
  ta_narrow_insn,        /* removed = -1 */
5359
  ta_widen_insn,         /* removed = +1 */
5360
  ta_fill,               /* removed = +size */
5361
  ta_remove_literal,
5362
  ta_add_literal
5363
};
5364
 
5365
 
5366
/* Structure for a text action record.  */
5367
struct text_action_struct
5368
{
5369
  text_action_t action;
5370
  asection *sec;        /* Optional */
5371
  bfd_vma offset;
5372
  bfd_vma virtual_offset;  /* Zero except for adding literals.  */
5373
  int removed_bytes;
5374
  literal_value value;  /* Only valid when adding literals.  */
5375
 
5376
  text_action *next;
5377
};
5378
 
5379
 
5380
/* List of all of the actions taken on a text section.  */
5381
struct text_action_list_struct
5382
{
5383
  text_action *head;
5384
};
5385
 
5386
 
5387
static text_action *
5388
find_fill_action (text_action_list *l, asection *sec, bfd_vma offset)
5389
{
5390
  text_action **m_p;
5391
 
5392
  /* It is not necessary to fill at the end of a section.  */
5393
  if (sec->size == offset)
5394
    return NULL;
5395
 
5396
  for (m_p = &l->head; *m_p && (*m_p)->offset <= offset; m_p = &(*m_p)->next)
5397
    {
5398
      text_action *t = *m_p;
5399
      /* When the action is another fill at the same address,
5400
         just increase the size.  */
5401
      if (t->offset == offset && t->action == ta_fill)
5402
        return t;
5403
    }
5404
  return NULL;
5405
}
5406
 
5407
 
5408
static int
5409
compute_removed_action_diff (const text_action *ta,
5410
                             asection *sec,
5411
                             bfd_vma offset,
5412
                             int removed,
5413
                             int removable_space)
5414
{
5415
  int new_removed;
5416
  int current_removed = 0;
5417
 
5418
  if (ta)
5419
    current_removed = ta->removed_bytes;
5420
 
5421
  BFD_ASSERT (ta == NULL || ta->offset == offset);
5422
  BFD_ASSERT (ta == NULL || ta->action == ta_fill);
5423
 
5424
  /* It is not necessary to fill at the end of a section.  Clean this up.  */
5425
  if (sec->size == offset)
5426
    new_removed = removable_space - 0;
5427
  else
5428
    {
5429
      int space;
5430
      int added = -removed - current_removed;
5431
      /* Ignore multiples of the section alignment.  */
5432
      added = ((1 << sec->alignment_power) - 1) & added;
5433
      new_removed = (-added);
5434
 
5435
      /* Modify for removable.  */
5436
      space = removable_space - new_removed;
5437
      new_removed = (removable_space
5438
                     - (((1 << sec->alignment_power) - 1) & space));
5439
    }
5440
  return (new_removed - current_removed);
5441
}
5442
 
5443
 
5444
static void
5445
adjust_fill_action (text_action *ta, int fill_diff)
5446
{
5447
  ta->removed_bytes += fill_diff;
5448
}
5449
 
5450
 
5451
/* Add a modification action to the text.  For the case of adding or
5452
   removing space, modify any current fill and assume that
5453
   "unreachable_space" bytes can be freely contracted.  Note that a
5454
   negative removed value is a fill.  */
5455
 
5456
static void
5457
text_action_add (text_action_list *l,
5458
                 text_action_t action,
5459
                 asection *sec,
5460
                 bfd_vma offset,
5461
                 int removed)
5462
{
5463
  text_action **m_p;
5464
  text_action *ta;
5465
 
5466
  /* It is not necessary to fill at the end of a section.  */
5467
  if (action == ta_fill && sec->size == offset)
5468
    return;
5469
 
5470
  /* It is not necessary to fill 0 bytes.  */
5471
  if (action == ta_fill && removed == 0)
5472
    return;
5473
 
5474
  for (m_p = &l->head; *m_p && (*m_p)->offset <= offset; m_p = &(*m_p)->next)
5475
    {
5476
      text_action *t = *m_p;
5477
 
5478
      if (action == ta_fill)
5479
        {
5480
          /* When the action is another fill at the same address,
5481
             just increase the size.  */
5482
          if (t->offset == offset && t->action == ta_fill)
5483
            {
5484
              t->removed_bytes += removed;
5485
              return;
5486
            }
5487
          /* Fills need to happen before widens so that we don't
5488
             insert fill bytes into the instruction stream.  */
5489
          if (t->offset == offset && t->action == ta_widen_insn)
5490
            break;
5491
        }
5492
    }
5493
 
5494
  /* Create a new record and fill it up.  */
5495
  ta = (text_action *) bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (text_action));
5496
  ta->action = action;
5497
  ta->sec = sec;
5498
  ta->offset = offset;
5499
  ta->removed_bytes = removed;
5500
  ta->next = (*m_p);
5501
  *m_p = ta;
5502
}
5503
 
5504
 
5505
static void
5506
text_action_add_literal (text_action_list *l,
5507
                         text_action_t action,
5508
                         const r_reloc *loc,
5509
                         const literal_value *value,
5510
                         int removed)
5511
{
5512
  text_action **m_p;
5513
  text_action *ta;
5514
  asection *sec = r_reloc_get_section (loc);
5515
  bfd_vma offset = loc->target_offset;
5516
  bfd_vma virtual_offset = loc->virtual_offset;
5517
 
5518
  BFD_ASSERT (action == ta_add_literal);
5519
 
5520
  for (m_p = &l->head; *m_p != NULL; m_p = &(*m_p)->next)
5521
    {
5522
      if ((*m_p)->offset > offset
5523
          && ((*m_p)->offset != offset
5524
              || (*m_p)->virtual_offset > virtual_offset))
5525
        break;
5526
    }
5527
 
5528
  /* Create a new record and fill it up.  */
5529
  ta = (text_action *) bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (text_action));
5530
  ta->action = action;
5531
  ta->sec = sec;
5532
  ta->offset = offset;
5533
  ta->virtual_offset = virtual_offset;
5534
  ta->value = *value;
5535
  ta->removed_bytes = removed;
5536
  ta->next = (*m_p);
5537
  *m_p = ta;
5538
}
5539
 
5540
 
5541
/* Find the total offset adjustment for the relaxations specified by
5542
   text_actions, beginning from a particular starting action.  This is
5543
   typically used from offset_with_removed_text to search an entire list of
5544
   actions, but it may also be called directly when adjusting adjacent offsets
5545
   so that each search may begin where the previous one left off.  */
5546
 
5547
static int
5548
removed_by_actions (text_action **p_start_action,
5549
                    bfd_vma offset,
5550
                    bfd_boolean before_fill)
5551
{
5552
  text_action *r;
5553
  int removed = 0;
5554
 
5555
  r = *p_start_action;
5556
  while (r)
5557
    {
5558
      if (r->offset > offset)
5559
        break;
5560
 
5561
      if (r->offset == offset
5562
          && (before_fill || r->action != ta_fill || r->removed_bytes >= 0))
5563
        break;
5564
 
5565
      removed += r->removed_bytes;
5566
 
5567
      r = r->next;
5568
    }
5569
 
5570
  *p_start_action = r;
5571
  return removed;
5572
}
5573
 
5574
 
5575
static bfd_vma
5576
offset_with_removed_text (text_action_list *action_list, bfd_vma offset)
5577
{
5578
  text_action *r = action_list->head;
5579
  return offset - removed_by_actions (&r, offset, FALSE);
5580
}
5581
 
5582
 
5583
static unsigned
5584
action_list_count (text_action_list *action_list)
5585
{
5586
  text_action *r = action_list->head;
5587
  unsigned count = 0;
5588
  for (r = action_list->head; r != NULL; r = r->next)
5589
    {
5590
      count++;
5591
    }
5592
  return count;
5593
}
5594
 
5595
 
5596
/* The find_insn_action routine will only find non-fill actions.  */
5597
 
5598
static text_action *
5599
find_insn_action (text_action_list *action_list, bfd_vma offset)
5600
{
5601
  text_action *t;
5602
  for (t = action_list->head; t; t = t->next)
5603
    {
5604
      if (t->offset == offset)
5605
        {
5606
          switch (t->action)
5607
            {
5608
            case ta_none:
5609
            case ta_fill:
5610
              break;
5611
            case ta_remove_insn:
5612
            case ta_remove_longcall:
5613
            case ta_convert_longcall:
5614
            case ta_narrow_insn:
5615
            case ta_widen_insn:
5616
              return t;
5617
            case ta_remove_literal:
5618
            case ta_add_literal:
5619
              BFD_ASSERT (0);
5620
              break;
5621
            }
5622
        }
5623
    }
5624
  return NULL;
5625
}
5626
 
5627
 
5628
#if DEBUG
5629
 
5630
static void
5631
print_action_list (FILE *fp, text_action_list *action_list)
5632
{
5633
  text_action *r;
5634
 
5635
  fprintf (fp, "Text Action\n");
5636
  for (r = action_list->head; r != NULL; r = r->next)
5637
    {
5638
      const char *t = "unknown";
5639
      switch (r->action)
5640
        {
5641
        case ta_remove_insn:
5642
          t = "remove_insn"; break;
5643
        case ta_remove_longcall:
5644
          t = "remove_longcall"; break;
5645
        case ta_convert_longcall:
5646
          t = "convert_longcall"; break;
5647
        case ta_narrow_insn:
5648
          t = "narrow_insn"; break;
5649
        case ta_widen_insn:
5650
          t = "widen_insn"; break;
5651
        case ta_fill:
5652
          t = "fill"; break;
5653
        case ta_none:
5654
          t = "none"; break;
5655
        case ta_remove_literal:
5656
          t = "remove_literal"; break;
5657
        case ta_add_literal:
5658
          t = "add_literal"; break;
5659
        }
5660
 
5661
      fprintf (fp, "%s: %s[0x%lx] \"%s\" %d\n",
5662
               r->sec->owner->filename,
5663
               r->sec->name, r->offset, t, r->removed_bytes);
5664
    }
5665
}
5666
 
5667
#endif /* DEBUG */
5668
 
5669
 
5670
/* Lists of literals being coalesced or removed.  */
5671
 
5672
/* In the usual case, the literal identified by "from" is being
5673
   coalesced with another literal identified by "to".  If the literal is
5674
   unused and is being removed altogether, "to.abfd" will be NULL.
5675
   The removed_literal entries are kept on a per-section list, sorted
5676
   by the "from" offset field.  */
5677
 
5678
typedef struct removed_literal_struct removed_literal;
5679
typedef struct removed_literal_list_struct removed_literal_list;
5680
 
5681
struct removed_literal_struct
5682
{
5683
  r_reloc from;
5684
  r_reloc to;
5685
  removed_literal *next;
5686
};
5687
 
5688
struct removed_literal_list_struct
5689
{
5690
  removed_literal *head;
5691
  removed_literal *tail;
5692
};
5693
 
5694
 
5695
/* Record that the literal at "from" is being removed.  If "to" is not
5696
   NULL, the "from" literal is being coalesced with the "to" literal.  */
5697
 
5698
static void
5699
add_removed_literal (removed_literal_list *removed_list,
5700
                     const r_reloc *from,
5701
                     const r_reloc *to)
5702
{
5703
  removed_literal *r, *new_r, *next_r;
5704
 
5705
  new_r = (removed_literal *) bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (removed_literal));
5706
 
5707
  new_r->from = *from;
5708
  if (to)
5709
    new_r->to = *to;
5710
  else
5711
    new_r->to.abfd = NULL;
5712
  new_r->next = NULL;
5713
 
5714
  r = removed_list->head;
5715
  if (r == NULL)
5716
    {
5717
      removed_list->head = new_r;
5718
      removed_list->tail = new_r;
5719
    }
5720
  /* Special check for common case of append.  */
5721
  else if (removed_list->tail->from.target_offset < from->target_offset)
5722
    {
5723
      removed_list->tail->next = new_r;
5724
      removed_list->tail = new_r;
5725
    }
5726
  else
5727
    {
5728
      while (r->from.target_offset < from->target_offset && r->next)
5729
        {
5730
          r = r->next;
5731
        }
5732
      next_r = r->next;
5733
      r->next = new_r;
5734
      new_r->next = next_r;
5735
      if (next_r == NULL)
5736
        removed_list->tail = new_r;
5737
    }
5738
}
5739
 
5740
 
5741
/* Check if the list of removed literals contains an entry for the
5742
   given address.  Return the entry if found.  */
5743
 
5744
static removed_literal *
5745
find_removed_literal (removed_literal_list *removed_list, bfd_vma addr)
5746
{
5747
  removed_literal *r = removed_list->head;
5748
  while (r && r->from.target_offset < addr)
5749
    r = r->next;
5750
  if (r && r->from.target_offset == addr)
5751
    return r;
5752
  return NULL;
5753
}
5754
 
5755
 
5756
#if DEBUG
5757
 
5758
static void
5759
print_removed_literals (FILE *fp, removed_literal_list *removed_list)
5760
{
5761
  removed_literal *r;
5762
  r = removed_list->head;
5763
  if (r)
5764
    fprintf (fp, "Removed Literals\n");
5765
  for (; r != NULL; r = r->next)
5766
    {
5767
      print_r_reloc (fp, &r->from);
5768
      fprintf (fp, " => ");
5769
      if (r->to.abfd == NULL)
5770
        fprintf (fp, "REMOVED");
5771
      else
5772
        print_r_reloc (fp, &r->to);
5773
      fprintf (fp, "\n");
5774
    }
5775
}
5776
 
5777
#endif /* DEBUG */
5778
 
5779
 
5780
/* Per-section data for relaxation.  */
5781
 
5782
typedef struct reloc_bfd_fix_struct reloc_bfd_fix;
5783
 
5784
struct xtensa_relax_info_struct
5785
{
5786
  bfd_boolean is_relaxable_literal_section;
5787
  bfd_boolean is_relaxable_asm_section;
5788
  int visited;                          /* Number of times visited.  */
5789
 
5790
  source_reloc *src_relocs;             /* Array[src_count].  */
5791
  int src_count;
5792
  int src_next;                         /* Next src_relocs entry to assign.  */
5793
 
5794
  removed_literal_list removed_list;
5795
  text_action_list action_list;
5796
 
5797
  reloc_bfd_fix *fix_list;
5798
  reloc_bfd_fix *fix_array;
5799
  unsigned fix_array_count;
5800
 
5801
  /* Support for expanding the reloc array that is stored
5802
     in the section structure.  If the relocations have been
5803
     reallocated, the newly allocated relocations will be referenced
5804
     here along with the actual size allocated.  The relocation
5805
     count will always be found in the section structure.  */
5806
  Elf_Internal_Rela *allocated_relocs;
5807
  unsigned relocs_count;
5808
  unsigned allocated_relocs_count;
5809
};
5810
 
5811
struct elf_xtensa_section_data
5812
{
5813
  struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
5814
  xtensa_relax_info relax_info;
5815
};
5816
 
5817
 
5818
static bfd_boolean
5819
elf_xtensa_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
5820
{
5821
  if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
5822
    {
5823
      struct elf_xtensa_section_data *sdata;
5824
      bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
5825
 
5826
      sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5827
      if (sdata == NULL)
5828
        return FALSE;
5829
      sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
5830
    }
5831
 
5832
  return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
5833
}
5834
 
5835
 
5836
static xtensa_relax_info *
5837
get_xtensa_relax_info (asection *sec)
5838
{
5839
  struct elf_xtensa_section_data *section_data;
5840
 
5841
  /* No info available if no section or if it is an output section.  */
5842
  if (!sec || sec == sec->output_section)
5843
    return NULL;
5844
 
5845
  section_data = (struct elf_xtensa_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec);
5846
  return &section_data->relax_info;
5847
}
5848
 
5849
 
5850
static void
5851
init_xtensa_relax_info (asection *sec)
5852
{
5853
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
5854
 
5855
  relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section = FALSE;
5856
  relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section = FALSE;
5857
  relax_info->visited = 0;
5858
 
5859
  relax_info->src_relocs = NULL;
5860
  relax_info->src_count = 0;
5861
  relax_info->src_next = 0;
5862
 
5863
  relax_info->removed_list.head = NULL;
5864
  relax_info->removed_list.tail = NULL;
5865
 
5866
  relax_info->action_list.head = NULL;
5867
 
5868
  relax_info->fix_list = NULL;
5869
  relax_info->fix_array = NULL;
5870
  relax_info->fix_array_count = 0;
5871
 
5872
  relax_info->allocated_relocs = NULL;
5873
  relax_info->relocs_count = 0;
5874
  relax_info->allocated_relocs_count = 0;
5875
}
5876
 
5877
 
5878
/* Coalescing literals may require a relocation to refer to a section in
5879
   a different input file, but the standard relocation information
5880
   cannot express that.  Instead, the reloc_bfd_fix structures are used
5881
   to "fix" the relocations that refer to sections in other input files.
5882
   These structures are kept on per-section lists.  The "src_type" field
5883
   records the relocation type in case there are multiple relocations on
5884
   the same location.  FIXME: This is ugly; an alternative might be to
5885
   add new symbols with the "owner" field to some other input file.  */
5886
 
5887
struct reloc_bfd_fix_struct
5888
{
5889
  asection *src_sec;
5890
  bfd_vma src_offset;
5891
  unsigned src_type;                    /* Relocation type.  */
5892
 
5893
  asection *target_sec;
5894
  bfd_vma target_offset;
5895
  bfd_boolean translated;
5896
 
5897
  reloc_bfd_fix *next;
5898
};
5899
 
5900
 
5901
static reloc_bfd_fix *
5902
reloc_bfd_fix_init (asection *src_sec,
5903
                    bfd_vma src_offset,
5904
                    unsigned src_type,
5905
                    asection *target_sec,
5906
                    bfd_vma target_offset,
5907
                    bfd_boolean translated)
5908
{
5909
  reloc_bfd_fix *fix;
5910
 
5911
  fix = (reloc_bfd_fix *) bfd_malloc (sizeof (reloc_bfd_fix));
5912
  fix->src_sec = src_sec;
5913
  fix->src_offset = src_offset;
5914
  fix->src_type = src_type;
5915
  fix->target_sec = target_sec;
5916
  fix->target_offset = target_offset;
5917
  fix->translated = translated;
5918
 
5919
  return fix;
5920
}
5921
 
5922
 
5923
static void
5924
add_fix (asection *src_sec, reloc_bfd_fix *fix)
5925
{
5926
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
5927
 
5928
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (src_sec);
5929
  fix->next = relax_info->fix_list;
5930
  relax_info->fix_list = fix;
5931
}
5932
 
5933
 
5934
static int
5935
fix_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
5936
{
5937
  const reloc_bfd_fix *a = (const reloc_bfd_fix *) ap;
5938
  const reloc_bfd_fix *b = (const reloc_bfd_fix *) bp;
5939
 
5940
  if (a->src_offset != b->src_offset)
5941
    return (a->src_offset - b->src_offset);
5942
  return (a->src_type - b->src_type);
5943
}
5944
 
5945
 
5946
static void
5947
cache_fix_array (asection *sec)
5948
{
5949
  unsigned i, count = 0;
5950
  reloc_bfd_fix *r;
5951
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
5952
 
5953
  if (relax_info == NULL)
5954
    return;
5955
  if (relax_info->fix_list == NULL)
5956
    return;
5957
 
5958
  for (r = relax_info->fix_list; r != NULL; r = r->next)
5959
    count++;
5960
 
5961
  relax_info->fix_array =
5962
    (reloc_bfd_fix *) bfd_malloc (sizeof (reloc_bfd_fix) * count);
5963
  relax_info->fix_array_count = count;
5964
 
5965
  r = relax_info->fix_list;
5966
  for (i = 0; i < count; i++, r = r->next)
5967
    {
5968
      relax_info->fix_array[count - 1 - i] = *r;
5969
      relax_info->fix_array[count - 1 - i].next = NULL;
5970
    }
5971
 
5972
  qsort (relax_info->fix_array, relax_info->fix_array_count,
5973
         sizeof (reloc_bfd_fix), fix_compare);
5974
}
5975
 
5976
 
5977
static reloc_bfd_fix *
5978
get_bfd_fix (asection *sec, bfd_vma offset, unsigned type)
5979
{
5980
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
5981
  reloc_bfd_fix *rv;
5982
  reloc_bfd_fix key;
5983
 
5984
  if (relax_info == NULL)
5985
    return NULL;
5986
  if (relax_info->fix_list == NULL)
5987
    return NULL;
5988
 
5989
  if (relax_info->fix_array == NULL)
5990
    cache_fix_array (sec);
5991
 
5992
  key.src_offset = offset;
5993
  key.src_type = type;
5994
  rv = bsearch (&key, relax_info->fix_array,  relax_info->fix_array_count,
5995
                sizeof (reloc_bfd_fix), fix_compare);
5996
  return rv;
5997
}
5998
 
5999
 
6000
/* Section caching.  */
6001
 
6002
typedef struct section_cache_struct section_cache_t;
6003
 
6004
struct section_cache_struct
6005
{
6006
  asection *sec;
6007
 
6008
  bfd_byte *contents;           /* Cache of the section contents.  */
6009
  bfd_size_type content_length;
6010
 
6011
  property_table_entry *ptbl;   /* Cache of the section property table.  */
6012
  unsigned pte_count;
6013
 
6014
  Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;    /* Cache of the section relocations.  */
6015
  unsigned reloc_count;
6016
};
6017
 
6018
 
6019
static void
6020
init_section_cache (section_cache_t *sec_cache)
6021
{
6022
  memset (sec_cache, 0, sizeof (*sec_cache));
6023
}
6024
 
6025
 
6026
static void
6027
clear_section_cache (section_cache_t *sec_cache)
6028
{
6029
  if (sec_cache->sec)
6030
    {
6031
      release_contents (sec_cache->sec, sec_cache->contents);
6032
      release_internal_relocs (sec_cache->sec, sec_cache->relocs);
6033
      if (sec_cache->ptbl)
6034
        free (sec_cache->ptbl);
6035
      memset (sec_cache, 0, sizeof (sec_cache));
6036
    }
6037
}
6038
 
6039
 
6040
static bfd_boolean
6041
section_cache_section (section_cache_t *sec_cache,
6042
                       asection *sec,
6043
                       struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6044
{
6045
  bfd *abfd;
6046
  property_table_entry *prop_table = NULL;
6047
  int ptblsize = 0;
6048
  bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6049
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6050
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
6051
 
6052
  if (sec == NULL)
6053
    return FALSE;
6054
  if (sec == sec_cache->sec)
6055
    return TRUE;
6056
 
6057
  abfd = sec->owner;
6058
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
6059
 
6060
  /* Get the contents.  */
6061
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
6062
  if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
6063
    goto err;
6064
 
6065
  /* Get the relocations.  */
6066
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
6067
                                              link_info->keep_memory);
6068
 
6069
  /* Get the entry table.  */
6070
  ptblsize = xtensa_read_table_entries (abfd, sec, &prop_table,
6071
                                        XTENSA_PROP_SEC_NAME, FALSE);
6072
  if (ptblsize < 0)
6073
    goto err;
6074
 
6075
  /* Fill in the new section cache.  */
6076
  clear_section_cache (sec_cache);
6077
  memset (sec_cache, 0, sizeof (sec_cache));
6078
 
6079
  sec_cache->sec = sec;
6080
  sec_cache->contents = contents;
6081
  sec_cache->content_length = sec_size;
6082
  sec_cache->relocs = internal_relocs;
6083
  sec_cache->reloc_count = sec->reloc_count;
6084
  sec_cache->pte_count = ptblsize;
6085
  sec_cache->ptbl = prop_table;
6086
 
6087
  return TRUE;
6088
 
6089
 err:
6090
  release_contents (sec, contents);
6091
  release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
6092
  if (prop_table)
6093
    free (prop_table);
6094
  return FALSE;
6095
}
6096
 
6097
 
6098
/* Extended basic blocks.  */
6099
 
6100
/* An ebb_struct represents an Extended Basic Block.  Within this
6101
   range, we guarantee that all instructions are decodable, the
6102
   property table entries are contiguous, and no property table
6103
   specifies a segment that cannot have instructions moved.  This
6104
   structure contains caches of the contents, property table and
6105
   relocations for the specified section for easy use.  The range is
6106
   specified by ranges of indices for the byte offset, property table
6107
   offsets and relocation offsets.  These must be consistent.  */
6108
 
6109
typedef struct ebb_struct ebb_t;
6110
 
6111
struct ebb_struct
6112
{
6113
  asection *sec;
6114
 
6115
  bfd_byte *contents;           /* Cache of the section contents.  */
6116
  bfd_size_type content_length;
6117
 
6118
  property_table_entry *ptbl;   /* Cache of the section property table.  */
6119
  unsigned pte_count;
6120
 
6121
  Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs;    /* Cache of the section relocations.  */
6122
  unsigned reloc_count;
6123
 
6124
  bfd_vma start_offset;         /* Offset in section.  */
6125
  unsigned start_ptbl_idx;      /* Offset in the property table.  */
6126
  unsigned start_reloc_idx;     /* Offset in the relocations.  */
6127
 
6128
  bfd_vma end_offset;
6129
  unsigned end_ptbl_idx;
6130
  unsigned end_reloc_idx;
6131
 
6132
  bfd_boolean ends_section;     /* Is this the last ebb in a section?  */
6133
 
6134
  /* The unreachable property table at the end of this set of blocks;
6135
     NULL if the end is not an unreachable block.  */
6136
  property_table_entry *ends_unreachable;
6137
};
6138
 
6139
 
6140
enum ebb_target_enum
6141
{
6142
  EBB_NO_ALIGN = 0,
6143
  EBB_DESIRE_TGT_ALIGN,
6144
  EBB_REQUIRE_TGT_ALIGN,
6145
  EBB_REQUIRE_LOOP_ALIGN,
6146
  EBB_REQUIRE_ALIGN
6147
};
6148
 
6149
 
6150
/* proposed_action_struct is similar to the text_action_struct except
6151
   that is represents a potential transformation, not one that will
6152
   occur.  We build a list of these for an extended basic block
6153
   and use them to compute the actual actions desired.  We must be
6154
   careful that the entire set of actual actions we perform do not
6155
   break any relocations that would fit if the actions were not
6156
   performed.  */
6157
 
6158
typedef struct proposed_action_struct proposed_action;
6159
 
6160
struct proposed_action_struct
6161
{
6162
  enum ebb_target_enum align_type; /* for the target alignment */
6163
  bfd_vma alignment_pow;
6164
  text_action_t action;
6165
  bfd_vma offset;
6166
  int removed_bytes;
6167
  bfd_boolean do_action; /* If false, then we will not perform the action.  */
6168
};
6169
 
6170
 
6171
/* The ebb_constraint_struct keeps a set of proposed actions for an
6172
   extended basic block.   */
6173
 
6174
typedef struct ebb_constraint_struct ebb_constraint;
6175
 
6176
struct ebb_constraint_struct
6177
{
6178
  ebb_t ebb;
6179
  bfd_boolean start_movable;
6180
 
6181
  /* Bytes of extra space at the beginning if movable.  */
6182
  int start_extra_space;
6183
 
6184
  enum ebb_target_enum start_align;
6185
 
6186
  bfd_boolean end_movable;
6187
 
6188
  /* Bytes of extra space at the end if movable.  */
6189
  int end_extra_space;
6190
 
6191
  unsigned action_count;
6192
  unsigned action_allocated;
6193
 
6194
  /* Array of proposed actions.  */
6195
  proposed_action *actions;
6196
 
6197
  /* Action alignments -- one for each proposed action.  */
6198
  enum ebb_target_enum *action_aligns;
6199
};
6200
 
6201
 
6202
static void
6203
init_ebb_constraint (ebb_constraint *c)
6204
{
6205
  memset (c, 0, sizeof (ebb_constraint));
6206
}
6207
 
6208
 
6209
static void
6210
free_ebb_constraint (ebb_constraint *c)
6211
{
6212
  if (c->actions)
6213
    free (c->actions);
6214
}
6215
 
6216
 
6217
static void
6218
init_ebb (ebb_t *ebb,
6219
          asection *sec,
6220
          bfd_byte *contents,
6221
          bfd_size_type content_length,
6222
          property_table_entry *prop_table,
6223
          unsigned ptblsize,
6224
          Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs,
6225
          unsigned reloc_count)
6226
{
6227
  memset (ebb, 0, sizeof (ebb_t));
6228
  ebb->sec = sec;
6229
  ebb->contents = contents;
6230
  ebb->content_length = content_length;
6231
  ebb->ptbl = prop_table;
6232
  ebb->pte_count = ptblsize;
6233
  ebb->relocs = internal_relocs;
6234
  ebb->reloc_count = reloc_count;
6235
  ebb->start_offset = 0;
6236
  ebb->end_offset = ebb->content_length - 1;
6237
  ebb->start_ptbl_idx = 0;
6238
  ebb->end_ptbl_idx = ptblsize;
6239
  ebb->start_reloc_idx = 0;
6240
  ebb->end_reloc_idx = reloc_count;
6241
}
6242
 
6243
 
6244
/* Extend the ebb to all decodable contiguous sections.  The algorithm
6245
   for building a basic block around an instruction is to push it
6246
   forward until we hit the end of a section, an unreachable block or
6247
   a block that cannot be transformed.  Then we push it backwards
6248
   searching for similar conditions.  */
6249
 
6250
static bfd_boolean extend_ebb_bounds_forward (ebb_t *);
6251
static bfd_boolean extend_ebb_bounds_backward (ebb_t *);
6252
static bfd_size_type insn_block_decodable_len
6253
  (bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type, bfd_vma, bfd_size_type);
6254
 
6255
static bfd_boolean
6256
extend_ebb_bounds (ebb_t *ebb)
6257
{
6258
  if (!extend_ebb_bounds_forward (ebb))
6259
    return FALSE;
6260
  if (!extend_ebb_bounds_backward (ebb))
6261
    return FALSE;
6262
  return TRUE;
6263
}
6264
 
6265
 
6266
static bfd_boolean
6267
extend_ebb_bounds_forward (ebb_t *ebb)
6268
{
6269
  property_table_entry *the_entry, *new_entry;
6270
 
6271
  the_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->end_ptbl_idx];
6272
 
6273
  /* Stop when (1) we cannot decode an instruction, (2) we are at
6274
     the end of the property tables, (3) we hit a non-contiguous property
6275
     table entry, (4) we hit a NO_TRANSFORM region.  */
6276
 
6277
  while (1)
6278
    {
6279
      bfd_vma entry_end;
6280
      bfd_size_type insn_block_len;
6281
 
6282
      entry_end = the_entry->address - ebb->sec->vma + the_entry->size;
6283
      insn_block_len =
6284
        insn_block_decodable_len (ebb->contents, ebb->content_length,
6285
                                  ebb->end_offset,
6286
                                  entry_end - ebb->end_offset);
6287
      if (insn_block_len != (entry_end - ebb->end_offset))
6288
        {
6289
          (*_bfd_error_handler)
6290
            (_("%B(%A+0x%lx): could not decode instruction; possible configuration mismatch"),
6291
             ebb->sec->owner, ebb->sec, ebb->end_offset + insn_block_len);
6292
          return FALSE;
6293
        }
6294
      ebb->end_offset += insn_block_len;
6295
 
6296
      if (ebb->end_offset == ebb->sec->size)
6297
        ebb->ends_section = TRUE;
6298
 
6299
      /* Update the reloc counter.  */
6300
      while (ebb->end_reloc_idx + 1 < ebb->reloc_count
6301
             && (ebb->relocs[ebb->end_reloc_idx + 1].r_offset
6302
                 < ebb->end_offset))
6303
        {
6304
          ebb->end_reloc_idx++;
6305
        }
6306
 
6307
      if (ebb->end_ptbl_idx + 1 == ebb->pte_count)
6308
        return TRUE;
6309
 
6310
      new_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->end_ptbl_idx + 1];
6311
      if (((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN) == 0)
6312
          || ((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM) != 0)
6313
          || ((the_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN) != 0))
6314
        break;
6315
 
6316
      if (the_entry->address + the_entry->size != new_entry->address)
6317
        break;
6318
 
6319
      the_entry = new_entry;
6320
      ebb->end_ptbl_idx++;
6321
    }
6322
 
6323
  /* Quick check for an unreachable or end of file just at the end.  */
6324
  if (ebb->end_ptbl_idx + 1 == ebb->pte_count)
6325
    {
6326
      if (ebb->end_offset == ebb->content_length)
6327
        ebb->ends_section = TRUE;
6328
    }
6329
  else
6330
    {
6331
      new_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->end_ptbl_idx + 1];
6332
      if ((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE) != 0
6333
          && the_entry->address + the_entry->size == new_entry->address)
6334
        ebb->ends_unreachable = new_entry;
6335
    }
6336
 
6337
  /* Any other ending requires exact alignment.  */
6338
  return TRUE;
6339
}
6340
 
6341
 
6342
static bfd_boolean
6343
extend_ebb_bounds_backward (ebb_t *ebb)
6344
{
6345
  property_table_entry *the_entry, *new_entry;
6346
 
6347
  the_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->start_ptbl_idx];
6348
 
6349
  /* Stop when (1) we cannot decode the instructions in the current entry.
6350
     (2) we are at the beginning of the property tables, (3) we hit a
6351
     non-contiguous property table entry, (4) we hit a NO_TRANSFORM region.  */
6352
 
6353
  while (1)
6354
    {
6355
      bfd_vma block_begin;
6356
      bfd_size_type insn_block_len;
6357
 
6358
      block_begin = the_entry->address - ebb->sec->vma;
6359
      insn_block_len =
6360
        insn_block_decodable_len (ebb->contents, ebb->content_length,
6361
                                  block_begin,
6362
                                  ebb->start_offset - block_begin);
6363
      if (insn_block_len != ebb->start_offset - block_begin)
6364
        {
6365
          (*_bfd_error_handler)
6366
            (_("%B(%A+0x%lx): could not decode instruction; possible configuration mismatch"),
6367
             ebb->sec->owner, ebb->sec, ebb->end_offset + insn_block_len);
6368
          return FALSE;
6369
        }
6370
      ebb->start_offset -= insn_block_len;
6371
 
6372
      /* Update the reloc counter.  */
6373
      while (ebb->start_reloc_idx > 0
6374
             && (ebb->relocs[ebb->start_reloc_idx - 1].r_offset
6375
                 >= ebb->start_offset))
6376
        {
6377
          ebb->start_reloc_idx--;
6378
        }
6379
 
6380
      if (ebb->start_ptbl_idx == 0)
6381
        return TRUE;
6382
 
6383
      new_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->start_ptbl_idx - 1];
6384
      if ((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN) == 0
6385
          || ((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM) != 0)
6386
          || ((new_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN) != 0))
6387
        return TRUE;
6388
      if (new_entry->address + new_entry->size != the_entry->address)
6389
        return TRUE;
6390
 
6391
      the_entry = new_entry;
6392
      ebb->start_ptbl_idx--;
6393
    }
6394
  return TRUE;
6395
}
6396
 
6397
 
6398
static bfd_size_type
6399
insn_block_decodable_len (bfd_byte *contents,
6400
                          bfd_size_type content_len,
6401
                          bfd_vma block_offset,
6402
                          bfd_size_type block_len)
6403
{
6404
  bfd_vma offset = block_offset;
6405
 
6406
  while (offset < block_offset + block_len)
6407
    {
6408
      bfd_size_type insn_len = 0;
6409
 
6410
      insn_len = insn_decode_len (contents, content_len, offset);
6411
      if (insn_len == 0)
6412
        return (offset - block_offset);
6413
      offset += insn_len;
6414
    }
6415
  return (offset - block_offset);
6416
}
6417
 
6418
 
6419
static void
6420
ebb_propose_action (ebb_constraint *c,
6421
                    enum ebb_target_enum align_type,
6422
                    bfd_vma alignment_pow,
6423
                    text_action_t action,
6424
                    bfd_vma offset,
6425
                    int removed_bytes,
6426
                    bfd_boolean do_action)
6427
{
6428
  proposed_action *act;
6429
 
6430
  if (c->action_allocated <= c->action_count)
6431
    {
6432
      unsigned new_allocated, i;
6433
      proposed_action *new_actions;
6434
 
6435
      new_allocated = (c->action_count + 2) * 2;
6436
      new_actions = (proposed_action *)
6437
        bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (proposed_action) * new_allocated);
6438
 
6439
      for (i = 0; i < c->action_count; i++)
6440
        new_actions[i] = c->actions[i];
6441
      if (c->actions)
6442
        free (c->actions);
6443
      c->actions = new_actions;
6444
      c->action_allocated = new_allocated;
6445
    }
6446
 
6447
  act = &c->actions[c->action_count];
6448
  act->align_type = align_type;
6449
  act->alignment_pow = alignment_pow;
6450
  act->action = action;
6451
  act->offset = offset;
6452
  act->removed_bytes = removed_bytes;
6453
  act->do_action = do_action;
6454
 
6455
  c->action_count++;
6456
}
6457
 
6458
 
6459
/* Access to internal relocations, section contents and symbols.  */
6460
 
6461
/* During relaxation, we need to modify relocations, section contents,
6462
   and symbol definitions, and we need to keep the original values from
6463
   being reloaded from the input files, i.e., we need to "pin" the
6464
   modified values in memory.  We also want to continue to observe the
6465
   setting of the "keep-memory" flag.  The following functions wrap the
6466
   standard BFD functions to take care of this for us.  */
6467
 
6468
static Elf_Internal_Rela *
6469
retrieve_internal_relocs (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, bfd_boolean keep_memory)
6470
{
6471
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
6472
 
6473
  if ((sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
6474
    return NULL;
6475
 
6476
  internal_relocs = elf_section_data (sec)->relocs;
6477
  if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6478
    internal_relocs = (_bfd_elf_link_read_relocs
6479
                       (abfd, sec, NULL, NULL, keep_memory));
6480
  return internal_relocs;
6481
}
6482
 
6483
 
6484
static void
6485
pin_internal_relocs (asection *sec, Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs)
6486
{
6487
  elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = internal_relocs;
6488
}
6489
 
6490
 
6491
static void
6492
release_internal_relocs (asection *sec, Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs)
6493
{
6494
  if (internal_relocs
6495
      && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6496
    free (internal_relocs);
6497
}
6498
 
6499
 
6500
static bfd_byte *
6501
retrieve_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, bfd_boolean keep_memory)
6502
{
6503
  bfd_byte *contents;
6504
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
6505
 
6506
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
6507
  contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
6508
 
6509
  if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
6510
    {
6511
      if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, &contents))
6512
        {
6513
          if (contents)
6514
            free (contents);
6515
          return NULL;
6516
        }
6517
      if (keep_memory)
6518
        elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6519
    }
6520
  return contents;
6521
}
6522
 
6523
 
6524
static void
6525
pin_contents (asection *sec, bfd_byte *contents)
6526
{
6527
  elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6528
}
6529
 
6530
 
6531
static void
6532
release_contents (asection *sec, bfd_byte *contents)
6533
{
6534
  if (contents && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6535
    free (contents);
6536
}
6537
 
6538
 
6539
static Elf_Internal_Sym *
6540
retrieve_local_syms (bfd *input_bfd)
6541
{
6542
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6543
  Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf;
6544
  size_t locsymcount;
6545
 
6546
  symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
6547
  locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6548
 
6549
  isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
6550
  if (isymbuf == NULL && locsymcount != 0)
6551
    isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, locsymcount, 0,
6552
                                    NULL, NULL, NULL);
6553
 
6554
  /* Save the symbols for this input file so they won't be read again.  */
6555
  if (isymbuf && isymbuf != (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents)
6556
    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6557
 
6558
  return isymbuf;
6559
}
6560
 
6561
 
6562
/* Code for link-time relaxation.  */
6563
 
6564
/* Initialization for relaxation: */
6565
static bfd_boolean analyze_relocations (struct bfd_link_info *);
6566
static bfd_boolean find_relaxable_sections
6567
  (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd_boolean *);
6568
static bfd_boolean collect_source_relocs
6569
  (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *);
6570
static bfd_boolean is_resolvable_asm_expansion
6571
  (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, Elf_Internal_Rela *, struct bfd_link_info *,
6572
   bfd_boolean *);
6573
static Elf_Internal_Rela *find_associated_l32r_irel
6574
  (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, Elf_Internal_Rela *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
6575
static bfd_boolean compute_text_actions
6576
  (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *);
6577
static bfd_boolean compute_ebb_proposed_actions (ebb_constraint *);
6578
static bfd_boolean compute_ebb_actions (ebb_constraint *);
6579
static bfd_boolean check_section_ebb_pcrels_fit
6580
  (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, Elf_Internal_Rela *, const ebb_constraint *,
6581
   const xtensa_opcode *);
6582
static bfd_boolean check_section_ebb_reduces (const ebb_constraint *);
6583
static void text_action_add_proposed
6584
  (text_action_list *, const ebb_constraint *, asection *);
6585
static int compute_fill_extra_space (property_table_entry *);
6586
 
6587
/* First pass: */
6588
static bfd_boolean compute_removed_literals
6589
  (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *, value_map_hash_table *);
6590
static Elf_Internal_Rela *get_irel_at_offset
6591
  (asection *, Elf_Internal_Rela *, bfd_vma);
6592
static bfd_boolean is_removable_literal
6593
  (const source_reloc *, int, const source_reloc *, int, asection *,
6594
   property_table_entry *, int);
6595
static bfd_boolean remove_dead_literal
6596
  (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *, Elf_Internal_Rela *,
6597
   Elf_Internal_Rela *, source_reloc *, property_table_entry *, int);
6598
static bfd_boolean identify_literal_placement
6599
  (bfd *, asection *, bfd_byte *, struct bfd_link_info *,
6600
   value_map_hash_table *, bfd_boolean *, Elf_Internal_Rela *, int,
6601
   source_reloc *, property_table_entry *, int, section_cache_t *,
6602
   bfd_boolean);
6603
static bfd_boolean relocations_reach (source_reloc *, int, const r_reloc *);
6604
static bfd_boolean coalesce_shared_literal
6605
  (asection *, source_reloc *, property_table_entry *, int, value_map *);
6606
static bfd_boolean move_shared_literal
6607
  (asection *, struct bfd_link_info *, source_reloc *, property_table_entry *,
6608
   int, const r_reloc *, const literal_value *, section_cache_t *);
6609
 
6610
/* Second pass: */
6611
static bfd_boolean relax_section (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *);
6612
static bfd_boolean translate_section_fixes (asection *);
6613
static bfd_boolean translate_reloc_bfd_fix (reloc_bfd_fix *);
6614
static asection *translate_reloc (const r_reloc *, r_reloc *, asection *);
6615
static void shrink_dynamic_reloc_sections
6616
  (struct bfd_link_info *, bfd *, asection *, Elf_Internal_Rela *);
6617
static bfd_boolean move_literal
6618
  (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, asection *, bfd_vma, bfd_byte *,
6619
   xtensa_relax_info *, Elf_Internal_Rela **, const literal_value *);
6620
static bfd_boolean relax_property_section
6621
  (bfd *, asection *, struct bfd_link_info *);
6622
 
6623
/* Third pass: */
6624
static bfd_boolean relax_section_symbols (bfd *, asection *);
6625
 
6626
 
6627
static bfd_boolean
6628
elf_xtensa_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6629
                          asection *sec,
6630
                          struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6631
                          bfd_boolean *again)
6632
{
6633
  static value_map_hash_table *values = NULL;
6634
  static bfd_boolean relocations_analyzed = FALSE;
6635
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
6636
 
6637
  if (!relocations_analyzed)
6638
    {
6639
      /* Do some overall initialization for relaxation.  */
6640
      values = value_map_hash_table_init ();
6641
      if (values == NULL)
6642
        return FALSE;
6643
      relaxing_section = TRUE;
6644
      if (!analyze_relocations (link_info))
6645
        return FALSE;
6646
      relocations_analyzed = TRUE;
6647
    }
6648
  *again = FALSE;
6649
 
6650
  /* Don't mess with linker-created sections.  */
6651
  if ((sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
6652
    return TRUE;
6653
 
6654
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
6655
  BFD_ASSERT (relax_info != NULL);
6656
 
6657
  switch (relax_info->visited)
6658
    {
6659
    case 0:
6660
      /* Note: It would be nice to fold this pass into
6661
         analyze_relocations, but it is important for this step that the
6662
         sections be examined in link order.  */
6663
      if (!compute_removed_literals (abfd, sec, link_info, values))
6664
        return FALSE;
6665
      *again = TRUE;
6666
      break;
6667
 
6668
    case 1:
6669
      if (values)
6670
        value_map_hash_table_delete (values);
6671
      values = NULL;
6672
      if (!relax_section (abfd, sec, link_info))
6673
        return FALSE;
6674
      *again = TRUE;
6675
      break;
6676
 
6677
    case 2:
6678
      if (!relax_section_symbols (abfd, sec))
6679
        return FALSE;
6680
      break;
6681
    }
6682
 
6683
  relax_info->visited++;
6684
  return TRUE;
6685
}
6686
 
6687
 
6688
/* Initialization for relaxation.  */
6689
 
6690
/* This function is called once at the start of relaxation.  It scans
6691
   all the input sections and marks the ones that are relaxable (i.e.,
6692
   literal sections with L32R relocations against them), and then
6693
   collects source_reloc information for all the relocations against
6694
   those relaxable sections.  During this process, it also detects
6695
   longcalls, i.e., calls relaxed by the assembler into indirect
6696
   calls, that can be optimized back into direct calls.  Within each
6697
   extended basic block (ebb) containing an optimized longcall, it
6698
   computes a set of "text actions" that can be performed to remove
6699
   the L32R associated with the longcall while optionally preserving
6700
   branch target alignments.  */
6701
 
6702
static bfd_boolean
6703
analyze_relocations (struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6704
{
6705
  bfd *abfd;
6706
  asection *sec;
6707
  bfd_boolean is_relaxable = FALSE;
6708
 
6709
  /* Initialize the per-section relaxation info.  */
6710
  for (abfd = link_info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link_next)
6711
    for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
6712
      {
6713
        init_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
6714
      }
6715
 
6716
  /* Mark relaxable sections (and count relocations against each one).  */
6717
  for (abfd = link_info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link_next)
6718
    for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
6719
      {
6720
        if (!find_relaxable_sections (abfd, sec, link_info, &is_relaxable))
6721
          return FALSE;
6722
      }
6723
 
6724
  /* Bail out if there are no relaxable sections.  */
6725
  if (!is_relaxable)
6726
    return TRUE;
6727
 
6728
  /* Allocate space for source_relocs.  */
6729
  for (abfd = link_info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link_next)
6730
    for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
6731
      {
6732
        xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
6733
 
6734
        relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
6735
        if (relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
6736
            || relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
6737
          {
6738
            relax_info->src_relocs = (source_reloc *)
6739
              bfd_malloc (relax_info->src_count * sizeof (source_reloc));
6740
          }
6741
        else
6742
          relax_info->src_count = 0;
6743
      }
6744
 
6745
  /* Collect info on relocations against each relaxable section.  */
6746
  for (abfd = link_info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link_next)
6747
    for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
6748
      {
6749
        if (!collect_source_relocs (abfd, sec, link_info))
6750
          return FALSE;
6751
      }
6752
 
6753
  /* Compute the text actions.  */
6754
  for (abfd = link_info->input_bfds; abfd != NULL; abfd = abfd->link_next)
6755
    for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
6756
      {
6757
        if (!compute_text_actions (abfd, sec, link_info))
6758
          return FALSE;
6759
      }
6760
 
6761
  return TRUE;
6762
}
6763
 
6764
 
6765
/* Find all the sections that might be relaxed.  The motivation for
6766
   this pass is that collect_source_relocs() needs to record _all_ the
6767
   relocations that target each relaxable section.  That is expensive
6768
   and unnecessary unless the target section is actually going to be
6769
   relaxed.  This pass identifies all such sections by checking if
6770
   they have L32Rs pointing to them.  In the process, the total number
6771
   of relocations targeting each section is also counted so that we
6772
   know how much space to allocate for source_relocs against each
6773
   relaxable literal section.  */
6774
 
6775
static bfd_boolean
6776
find_relaxable_sections (bfd *abfd,
6777
                         asection *sec,
6778
                         struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6779
                         bfd_boolean *is_relaxable_p)
6780
{
6781
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
6782
  bfd_byte *contents;
6783
  bfd_boolean ok = TRUE;
6784
  unsigned i;
6785
  xtensa_relax_info *source_relax_info;
6786
  bfd_boolean is_l32r_reloc;
6787
 
6788
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
6789
                                              link_info->keep_memory);
6790
  if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6791
    return ok;
6792
 
6793
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
6794
  if (contents == NULL && sec->size != 0)
6795
    {
6796
      ok = FALSE;
6797
      goto error_return;
6798
    }
6799
 
6800
  source_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
6801
  for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
6802
    {
6803
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
6804
      r_reloc r_rel;
6805
      asection *target_sec;
6806
      xtensa_relax_info *target_relax_info;
6807
 
6808
      /* If this section has not already been marked as "relaxable", and
6809
         if it contains any ASM_EXPAND relocations (marking expanded
6810
         longcalls) that can be optimized into direct calls, then mark
6811
         the section as "relaxable".  */
6812
      if (source_relax_info
6813
          && !source_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section
6814
          && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) == R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND)
6815
        {
6816
          bfd_boolean is_reachable = FALSE;
6817
          if (is_resolvable_asm_expansion (abfd, sec, contents, irel,
6818
                                           link_info, &is_reachable)
6819
              && is_reachable)
6820
            {
6821
              source_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section = TRUE;
6822
              *is_relaxable_p = TRUE;
6823
            }
6824
        }
6825
 
6826
      r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents,
6827
                    bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec));
6828
 
6829
      target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
6830
      target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
6831
      if (!target_relax_info)
6832
        continue;
6833
 
6834
      /* Count PC-relative operand relocations against the target section.
6835
         Note: The conditions tested here must match the conditions under
6836
         which init_source_reloc is called in collect_source_relocs().  */
6837
      is_l32r_reloc = FALSE;
6838
      if (is_operand_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
6839
        {
6840
          xtensa_opcode opcode =
6841
            get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
6842
          if (opcode != XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
6843
            {
6844
              is_l32r_reloc = (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ());
6845
              if (!is_alt_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info))
6846
                  || is_l32r_reloc)
6847
                target_relax_info->src_count++;
6848
            }
6849
        }
6850
 
6851
      if (is_l32r_reloc && r_reloc_is_defined (&r_rel))
6852
        {
6853
          /* Mark the target section as relaxable.  */
6854
          target_relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section = TRUE;
6855
          *is_relaxable_p = TRUE;
6856
        }
6857
    }
6858
 
6859
 error_return:
6860
  release_contents (sec, contents);
6861
  release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
6862
  return ok;
6863
}
6864
 
6865
 
6866
/* Record _all_ the relocations that point to relaxable sections, and
6867
   get rid of ASM_EXPAND relocs by either converting them to
6868
   ASM_SIMPLIFY or by removing them.  */
6869
 
6870
static bfd_boolean
6871
collect_source_relocs (bfd *abfd,
6872
                       asection *sec,
6873
                       struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6874
{
6875
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
6876
  bfd_byte *contents;
6877
  bfd_boolean ok = TRUE;
6878
  unsigned i;
6879
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
6880
 
6881
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
6882
                                              link_info->keep_memory);
6883
  if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6884
    return ok;
6885
 
6886
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
6887
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
6888
  if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
6889
    {
6890
      ok = FALSE;
6891
      goto error_return;
6892
    }
6893
 
6894
  /* Record relocations against relaxable literal sections.  */
6895
  for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
6896
    {
6897
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
6898
      r_reloc r_rel;
6899
      asection *target_sec;
6900
      xtensa_relax_info *target_relax_info;
6901
 
6902
      r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
6903
 
6904
      target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
6905
      target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
6906
 
6907
      if (target_relax_info
6908
          && (target_relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
6909
              || target_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section))
6910
        {
6911
          xtensa_opcode opcode = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
6912
          int opnd = -1;
6913
          bfd_boolean is_abs_literal = FALSE;
6914
 
6915
          if (is_alt_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
6916
            {
6917
              /* None of the current alternate relocs are PC-relative,
6918
                 and only PC-relative relocs matter here.  However, we
6919
                 still need to record the opcode for literal
6920
                 coalescing.  */
6921
              opcode = get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
6922
              if (opcode == get_l32r_opcode ())
6923
                {
6924
                  is_abs_literal = TRUE;
6925
                  opnd = 1;
6926
                }
6927
              else
6928
                opcode = XTENSA_UNDEFINED;
6929
            }
6930
          else if (is_operand_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
6931
            {
6932
              opcode = get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
6933
              opnd = get_relocation_opnd (opcode, ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info));
6934
            }
6935
 
6936
          if (opcode != XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
6937
            {
6938
              int src_next = target_relax_info->src_next++;
6939
              source_reloc *s_reloc = &target_relax_info->src_relocs[src_next];
6940
 
6941
              init_source_reloc (s_reloc, sec, &r_rel, opcode, opnd,
6942
                                 is_abs_literal);
6943
            }
6944
        }
6945
    }
6946
 
6947
  /* Now get rid of ASM_EXPAND relocations.  At this point, the
6948
     src_relocs array for the target literal section may still be
6949
     incomplete, but it must at least contain the entries for the L32R
6950
     relocations associated with ASM_EXPANDs because they were just
6951
     added in the preceding loop over the relocations.  */
6952
 
6953
  for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
6954
    {
6955
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
6956
      bfd_boolean is_reachable;
6957
 
6958
      if (!is_resolvable_asm_expansion (abfd, sec, contents, irel, link_info,
6959
                                        &is_reachable))
6960
        continue;
6961
 
6962
      if (is_reachable)
6963
        {
6964
          Elf_Internal_Rela *l32r_irel;
6965
          r_reloc r_rel;
6966
          asection *target_sec;
6967
          xtensa_relax_info *target_relax_info;
6968
 
6969
          /* Mark the source_reloc for the L32R so that it will be
6970
             removed in compute_removed_literals(), along with the
6971
             associated literal.  */
6972
          l32r_irel = find_associated_l32r_irel (abfd, sec, contents,
6973
                                                 irel, internal_relocs);
6974
          if (l32r_irel == NULL)
6975
            continue;
6976
 
6977
          r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, l32r_irel, contents, sec_size);
6978
 
6979
          target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
6980
          target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
6981
 
6982
          if (target_relax_info
6983
              && (target_relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
6984
                  || target_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section))
6985
            {
6986
              source_reloc *s_reloc;
6987
 
6988
              /* Search the source_relocs for the entry corresponding to
6989
                 the l32r_irel.  Note: The src_relocs array is not yet
6990
                 sorted, but it wouldn't matter anyway because we're
6991
                 searching by source offset instead of target offset.  */
6992
              s_reloc = find_source_reloc (target_relax_info->src_relocs,
6993
                                           target_relax_info->src_next,
6994
                                           sec, l32r_irel);
6995
              BFD_ASSERT (s_reloc);
6996
              s_reloc->is_null = TRUE;
6997
            }
6998
 
6999
          /* Convert this reloc to ASM_SIMPLIFY.  */
7000
          irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
7001
                                       R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY);
7002
          l32r_irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
7003
 
7004
          pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
7005
        }
7006
      else
7007
        {
7008
          /* It is resolvable but doesn't reach.  We resolve now
7009
             by eliminating the relocation -- the call will remain
7010
             expanded into L32R/CALLX.  */
7011
          irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
7012
          pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
7013
        }
7014
    }
7015
 
7016
 error_return:
7017
  release_contents (sec, contents);
7018
  release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
7019
  return ok;
7020
}
7021
 
7022
 
7023
/* Return TRUE if the asm expansion can be resolved.  Generally it can
7024
   be resolved on a final link or when a partial link locates it in the
7025
   same section as the target.  Set "is_reachable" flag if the target of
7026
   the call is within the range of a direct call, given the current VMA
7027
   for this section and the target section.  */
7028
 
7029
bfd_boolean
7030
is_resolvable_asm_expansion (bfd *abfd,
7031
                             asection *sec,
7032
                             bfd_byte *contents,
7033
                             Elf_Internal_Rela *irel,
7034
                             struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
7035
                             bfd_boolean *is_reachable_p)
7036
{
7037
  asection *target_sec;
7038
  bfd_vma target_offset;
7039
  r_reloc r_rel;
7040
  xtensa_opcode opcode, direct_call_opcode;
7041
  bfd_vma self_address;
7042
  bfd_vma dest_address;
7043
  bfd_boolean uses_l32r;
7044
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
7045
 
7046
  *is_reachable_p = FALSE;
7047
 
7048
  if (contents == NULL)
7049
    return FALSE;
7050
 
7051
  if (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND)
7052
    return FALSE;
7053
 
7054
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
7055
  opcode = get_expanded_call_opcode (contents + irel->r_offset,
7056
                                     sec_size - irel->r_offset, &uses_l32r);
7057
  /* Optimization of longcalls that use CONST16 is not yet implemented.  */
7058
  if (!uses_l32r)
7059
    return FALSE;
7060
 
7061
  direct_call_opcode = swap_callx_for_call_opcode (opcode);
7062
  if (direct_call_opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
7063
    return FALSE;
7064
 
7065
  /* Check and see that the target resolves.  */
7066
  r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
7067
  if (!r_reloc_is_defined (&r_rel))
7068
    return FALSE;
7069
 
7070
  target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
7071
  target_offset = r_rel.target_offset;
7072
 
7073
  /* If the target is in a shared library, then it doesn't reach.  This
7074
     isn't supposed to come up because the compiler should never generate
7075
     non-PIC calls on systems that use shared libraries, but the linker
7076
     shouldn't crash regardless.  */
7077
  if (!target_sec->output_section)
7078
    return FALSE;
7079
 
7080
  /* For relocatable sections, we can only simplify when the output
7081
     section of the target is the same as the output section of the
7082
     source.  */
7083
  if (link_info->relocatable
7084
      && (target_sec->output_section != sec->output_section
7085
          || is_reloc_sym_weak (abfd, irel)))
7086
    return FALSE;
7087
 
7088
  self_address = (sec->output_section->vma
7089
                  + sec->output_offset + irel->r_offset + 3);
7090
  dest_address = (target_sec->output_section->vma
7091
                  + target_sec->output_offset + target_offset);
7092
 
7093
  *is_reachable_p = pcrel_reloc_fits (direct_call_opcode, 0,
7094
                                      self_address, dest_address);
7095
 
7096
  if ((self_address >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS) !=
7097
      (dest_address >> CALL_SEGMENT_BITS))
7098
    return FALSE;
7099
 
7100
  return TRUE;
7101
}
7102
 
7103
 
7104
static Elf_Internal_Rela *
7105
find_associated_l32r_irel (bfd *abfd,
7106
                           asection *sec,
7107
                           bfd_byte *contents,
7108
                           Elf_Internal_Rela *other_irel,
7109
                           Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs)
7110
{
7111
  unsigned i;
7112
 
7113
  for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
7114
    {
7115
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
7116
 
7117
      if (irel == other_irel)
7118
        continue;
7119
      if (irel->r_offset != other_irel->r_offset)
7120
        continue;
7121
      if (is_l32r_relocation (abfd, sec, contents, irel))
7122
        return irel;
7123
    }
7124
 
7125
  return NULL;
7126
}
7127
 
7128
 
7129
static xtensa_opcode *
7130
build_reloc_opcodes (bfd *abfd,
7131
                     asection *sec,
7132
                     bfd_byte *contents,
7133
                     Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs)
7134
{
7135
  unsigned i;
7136
  xtensa_opcode *reloc_opcodes =
7137
    (xtensa_opcode *) bfd_malloc (sizeof (xtensa_opcode) * sec->reloc_count);
7138
  for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
7139
    {
7140
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
7141
      reloc_opcodes[i] = get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
7142
    }
7143
  return reloc_opcodes;
7144
}
7145
 
7146
 
7147
/* The compute_text_actions function will build a list of potential
7148
   transformation actions for code in the extended basic block of each
7149
   longcall that is optimized to a direct call.  From this list we
7150
   generate a set of actions to actually perform that optimizes for
7151
   space and, if not using size_opt, maintains branch target
7152
   alignments.
7153
 
7154
   These actions to be performed are placed on a per-section list.
7155
   The actual changes are performed by relax_section() in the second
7156
   pass.  */
7157
 
7158
bfd_boolean
7159
compute_text_actions (bfd *abfd,
7160
                      asection *sec,
7161
                      struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
7162
{
7163
  xtensa_opcode *reloc_opcodes = NULL;
7164
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
7165
  bfd_byte *contents;
7166
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
7167
  bfd_boolean ok = TRUE;
7168
  unsigned i;
7169
  property_table_entry *prop_table = 0;
7170
  int ptblsize = 0;
7171
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
7172
 
7173
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
7174
  BFD_ASSERT (relax_info);
7175
  BFD_ASSERT (relax_info->src_next == relax_info->src_count);
7176
 
7177
  /* Do nothing if the section contains no optimized longcalls.  */
7178
  if (!relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
7179
    return ok;
7180
 
7181
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
7182
                                              link_info->keep_memory);
7183
 
7184
  if (internal_relocs)
7185
    qsort (internal_relocs, sec->reloc_count, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela),
7186
           internal_reloc_compare);
7187
 
7188
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
7189
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
7190
  if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
7191
    {
7192
      ok = FALSE;
7193
      goto error_return;
7194
    }
7195
 
7196
  ptblsize = xtensa_read_table_entries (abfd, sec, &prop_table,
7197
                                        XTENSA_PROP_SEC_NAME, FALSE);
7198
  if (ptblsize < 0)
7199
    {
7200
      ok = FALSE;
7201
      goto error_return;
7202
    }
7203
 
7204
  for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
7205
    {
7206
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
7207
      bfd_vma r_offset;
7208
      property_table_entry *the_entry;
7209
      int ptbl_idx;
7210
      ebb_t *ebb;
7211
      ebb_constraint ebb_table;
7212
      bfd_size_type simplify_size;
7213
 
7214
      if (irel && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY)
7215
        continue;
7216
      r_offset = irel->r_offset;
7217
 
7218
      simplify_size = get_asm_simplify_size (contents, sec_size, r_offset);
7219
      if (simplify_size == 0)
7220
        {
7221
          (*_bfd_error_handler)
7222
            (_("%B(%A+0x%lx): could not decode instruction for XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY relocation; possible configuration mismatch"),
7223
             sec->owner, sec, r_offset);
7224
          continue;
7225
        }
7226
 
7227
      /* If the instruction table is not around, then don't do this
7228
         relaxation.  */
7229
      the_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
7230
                                                  sec->vma + irel->r_offset);
7231
      if (the_entry == NULL || XTENSA_NO_NOP_REMOVAL)
7232
        {
7233
          text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
7234
                           ta_convert_longcall, sec, r_offset,
7235
                           0);
7236
          continue;
7237
        }
7238
 
7239
      /* If the next longcall happens to be at the same address as an
7240
         unreachable section of size 0, then skip forward.  */
7241
      ptbl_idx = the_entry - prop_table;
7242
      while ((the_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE)
7243
             && the_entry->size == 0
7244
             && ptbl_idx + 1 < ptblsize
7245
             && (prop_table[ptbl_idx + 1].address
7246
                 == prop_table[ptbl_idx].address))
7247
        {
7248
          ptbl_idx++;
7249
          the_entry++;
7250
        }
7251
 
7252
      if (the_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM)
7253
          /* NO_REORDER is OK */
7254
        continue;
7255
 
7256
      init_ebb_constraint (&ebb_table);
7257
      ebb = &ebb_table.ebb;
7258
      init_ebb (ebb, sec, contents, sec_size, prop_table, ptblsize,
7259
                internal_relocs, sec->reloc_count);
7260
      ebb->start_offset = r_offset + simplify_size;
7261
      ebb->end_offset = r_offset + simplify_size;
7262
      ebb->start_ptbl_idx = ptbl_idx;
7263
      ebb->end_ptbl_idx = ptbl_idx;
7264
      ebb->start_reloc_idx = i;
7265
      ebb->end_reloc_idx = i;
7266
 
7267
      /* Precompute the opcode for each relocation.  */
7268
      if (reloc_opcodes == NULL)
7269
        reloc_opcodes = build_reloc_opcodes (abfd, sec, contents,
7270
                                             internal_relocs);
7271
 
7272
      if (!extend_ebb_bounds (ebb)
7273
          || !compute_ebb_proposed_actions (&ebb_table)
7274
          || !compute_ebb_actions (&ebb_table)
7275
          || !check_section_ebb_pcrels_fit (abfd, sec, contents,
7276
                                            internal_relocs, &ebb_table,
7277
                                            reloc_opcodes)
7278
          || !check_section_ebb_reduces (&ebb_table))
7279
        {
7280
          /* If anything goes wrong or we get unlucky and something does
7281
             not fit, with our plan because of expansion between
7282
             critical branches, just convert to a NOP.  */
7283
 
7284
          text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
7285
                           ta_convert_longcall, sec, r_offset, 0);
7286
          i = ebb_table.ebb.end_reloc_idx;
7287
          free_ebb_constraint (&ebb_table);
7288
          continue;
7289
        }
7290
 
7291
      text_action_add_proposed (&relax_info->action_list, &ebb_table, sec);
7292
 
7293
      /* Update the index so we do not go looking at the relocations
7294
         we have already processed.  */
7295
      i = ebb_table.ebb.end_reloc_idx;
7296
      free_ebb_constraint (&ebb_table);
7297
    }
7298
 
7299
#if DEBUG
7300
  if (relax_info->action_list.head)
7301
    print_action_list (stderr, &relax_info->action_list);
7302
#endif
7303
 
7304
error_return:
7305
  release_contents (sec, contents);
7306
  release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
7307
  if (prop_table)
7308
    free (prop_table);
7309
  if (reloc_opcodes)
7310
    free (reloc_opcodes);
7311
 
7312
  return ok;
7313
}
7314
 
7315
 
7316
/* Do not widen an instruction if it is preceeded by a
7317
   loop opcode.  It might cause misalignment.  */
7318
 
7319
static bfd_boolean
7320
prev_instr_is_a_loop (bfd_byte *contents,
7321
                      bfd_size_type content_length,
7322
                      bfd_size_type offset)
7323
{
7324
  xtensa_opcode prev_opcode;
7325
 
7326
  if (offset < 3)
7327
    return FALSE;
7328
  prev_opcode = insn_decode_opcode (contents, content_length, offset-3, 0);
7329
  return (xtensa_opcode_is_loop (xtensa_default_isa, prev_opcode) == 1);
7330
}
7331
 
7332
 
7333
/* Find all of the possible actions for an extended basic block.  */
7334
 
7335
bfd_boolean
7336
compute_ebb_proposed_actions (ebb_constraint *ebb_table)
7337
{
7338
  const ebb_t *ebb = &ebb_table->ebb;
7339
  unsigned rel_idx = ebb->start_reloc_idx;
7340
  property_table_entry *entry, *start_entry, *end_entry;
7341
  bfd_vma offset = 0;
7342
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
7343
  xtensa_format fmt;
7344
  static xtensa_insnbuf insnbuf = NULL;
7345
  static xtensa_insnbuf slotbuf = NULL;
7346
 
7347
  if (insnbuf == NULL)
7348
    {
7349
      insnbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
7350
      slotbuf = xtensa_insnbuf_alloc (isa);
7351
    }
7352
 
7353
  start_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->start_ptbl_idx];
7354
  end_entry = &ebb->ptbl[ebb->end_ptbl_idx];
7355
 
7356
  for (entry = start_entry; entry <= end_entry; entry++)
7357
    {
7358
      bfd_vma start_offset, end_offset;
7359
      bfd_size_type insn_len;
7360
 
7361
      start_offset = entry->address - ebb->sec->vma;
7362
      end_offset = entry->address + entry->size - ebb->sec->vma;
7363
 
7364
      if (entry == start_entry)
7365
        start_offset = ebb->start_offset;
7366
      if (entry == end_entry)
7367
        end_offset = ebb->end_offset;
7368
      offset = start_offset;
7369
 
7370
      if (offset == entry->address - ebb->sec->vma
7371
          && (entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN_BRANCH_TARGET) != 0)
7372
        {
7373
          enum ebb_target_enum align_type = EBB_DESIRE_TGT_ALIGN;
7374
          BFD_ASSERT (offset != end_offset);
7375
          if (offset == end_offset)
7376
            return FALSE;
7377
 
7378
          insn_len = insn_decode_len (ebb->contents, ebb->content_length,
7379
                                      offset);
7380
          if (insn_len == 0)
7381
            goto decode_error;
7382
 
7383
          if (check_branch_target_aligned_address (offset, insn_len))
7384
            align_type = EBB_REQUIRE_TGT_ALIGN;
7385
 
7386
          ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, align_type, 0,
7387
                              ta_none, offset, 0, TRUE);
7388
        }
7389
 
7390
      while (offset != end_offset)
7391
        {
7392
          Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
7393
          xtensa_opcode opcode;
7394
 
7395
          while (rel_idx < ebb->end_reloc_idx
7396
                 && (ebb->relocs[rel_idx].r_offset < offset
7397
                     || (ebb->relocs[rel_idx].r_offset == offset
7398
                         && (ELF32_R_TYPE (ebb->relocs[rel_idx].r_info)
7399
                             != R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY))))
7400
            rel_idx++;
7401
 
7402
          /* Check for longcall.  */
7403
          irel = &ebb->relocs[rel_idx];
7404
          if (irel->r_offset == offset
7405
              && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) == R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY)
7406
            {
7407
              bfd_size_type simplify_size;
7408
 
7409
              simplify_size = get_asm_simplify_size (ebb->contents,
7410
                                                     ebb->content_length,
7411
                                                     irel->r_offset);
7412
              if (simplify_size == 0)
7413
                goto decode_error;
7414
 
7415
              ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, EBB_NO_ALIGN, 0,
7416
                                  ta_convert_longcall, offset, 0, TRUE);
7417
 
7418
              offset += simplify_size;
7419
              continue;
7420
            }
7421
 
7422
          if (offset + MIN_INSN_LENGTH > ebb->content_length)
7423
            goto decode_error;
7424
          xtensa_insnbuf_from_chars (isa, insnbuf, &ebb->contents[offset],
7425
                                     ebb->content_length - offset);
7426
          fmt = xtensa_format_decode (isa, insnbuf);
7427
          if (fmt == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
7428
            goto decode_error;
7429
          insn_len = xtensa_format_length (isa, fmt);
7430
          if (insn_len == (bfd_size_type) XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
7431
            goto decode_error;
7432
 
7433
          if (xtensa_format_num_slots (isa, fmt) != 1)
7434
            {
7435
              offset += insn_len;
7436
              continue;
7437
            }
7438
 
7439
          xtensa_format_get_slot (isa, fmt, 0, insnbuf, slotbuf);
7440
          opcode = xtensa_opcode_decode (isa, fmt, 0, slotbuf);
7441
          if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
7442
            goto decode_error;
7443
 
7444
          if ((entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN_NO_DENSITY) == 0
7445
              && (entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM) == 0
7446
              && can_narrow_instruction (slotbuf, fmt, opcode) != 0)
7447
            {
7448
              /* Add an instruction narrow action.  */
7449
              ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, EBB_NO_ALIGN, 0,
7450
                                  ta_narrow_insn, offset, 0, FALSE);
7451
            }
7452
          else if ((entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM) == 0
7453
                   && can_widen_instruction (slotbuf, fmt, opcode) != 0
7454
                   && ! prev_instr_is_a_loop (ebb->contents,
7455
                                              ebb->content_length, offset))
7456
            {
7457
              /* Add an instruction widen action.  */
7458
              ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, EBB_NO_ALIGN, 0,
7459
                                  ta_widen_insn, offset, 0, FALSE);
7460
            }
7461
          else if (xtensa_opcode_is_loop (xtensa_default_isa, opcode) == 1)
7462
            {
7463
              /* Check for branch targets.  */
7464
              ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, EBB_REQUIRE_LOOP_ALIGN, 0,
7465
                                  ta_none, offset, 0, TRUE);
7466
            }
7467
 
7468
          offset += insn_len;
7469
        }
7470
    }
7471
 
7472
  if (ebb->ends_unreachable)
7473
    {
7474
      ebb_propose_action (ebb_table, EBB_NO_ALIGN, 0,
7475
                          ta_fill, ebb->end_offset, 0, TRUE);
7476
    }
7477
 
7478
  return TRUE;
7479
 
7480
 decode_error:
7481
  (*_bfd_error_handler)
7482
    (_("%B(%A+0x%lx): could not decode instruction; possible configuration mismatch"),
7483
     ebb->sec->owner, ebb->sec, offset);
7484
  return FALSE;
7485
}
7486
 
7487
 
7488
/* After all of the information has collected about the
7489
   transformations possible in an EBB, compute the appropriate actions
7490
   here in compute_ebb_actions.  We still must check later to make
7491
   sure that the actions do not break any relocations.  The algorithm
7492
   used here is pretty greedy.  Basically, it removes as many no-ops
7493
   as possible so that the end of the EBB has the same alignment
7494
   characteristics as the original.  First, it uses narrowing, then
7495
   fill space at the end of the EBB, and finally widenings.  If that
7496
   does not work, it tries again with one fewer no-op removed.  The
7497
   optimization will only be performed if all of the branch targets
7498
   that were aligned before transformation are also aligned after the
7499
   transformation.
7500
 
7501
   When the size_opt flag is set, ignore the branch target alignments,
7502
   narrow all wide instructions, and remove all no-ops unless the end
7503
   of the EBB prevents it.  */
7504
 
7505
bfd_boolean
7506
compute_ebb_actions (ebb_constraint *ebb_table)
7507
{
7508
  unsigned i = 0;
7509
  unsigned j;
7510
  int removed_bytes = 0;
7511
  ebb_t *ebb = &ebb_table->ebb;
7512
  unsigned seg_idx_start = 0;
7513
  unsigned seg_idx_end = 0;
7514
 
7515
  /* We perform this like the assembler relaxation algorithm: Start by
7516
     assuming all instructions are narrow and all no-ops removed; then
7517
     walk through....  */
7518
 
7519
  /* For each segment of this that has a solid constraint, check to
7520
     see if there are any combinations that will keep the constraint.
7521
     If so, use it.  */
7522
  for (seg_idx_end = 0; seg_idx_end < ebb_table->action_count; seg_idx_end++)
7523
    {
7524
      bfd_boolean requires_text_end_align = FALSE;
7525
      unsigned longcall_count = 0;
7526
      unsigned longcall_convert_count = 0;
7527
      unsigned narrowable_count = 0;
7528
      unsigned narrowable_convert_count = 0;
7529
      unsigned widenable_count = 0;
7530
      unsigned widenable_convert_count = 0;
7531
 
7532
      proposed_action *action = NULL;
7533
      int align = (1 << ebb_table->ebb.sec->alignment_power);
7534
 
7535
      seg_idx_start = seg_idx_end;
7536
 
7537
      for (i = seg_idx_start; i < ebb_table->action_count; i++)
7538
        {
7539
          action = &ebb_table->actions[i];
7540
          if (action->action == ta_convert_longcall)
7541
            longcall_count++;
7542
          if (action->action == ta_narrow_insn)
7543
            narrowable_count++;
7544
          if (action->action == ta_widen_insn)
7545
            widenable_count++;
7546
          if (action->action == ta_fill)
7547
            break;
7548
          if (action->align_type == EBB_REQUIRE_LOOP_ALIGN)
7549
            break;
7550
          if (action->align_type == EBB_REQUIRE_TGT_ALIGN
7551
              && !elf32xtensa_size_opt)
7552
            break;
7553
        }
7554
      seg_idx_end = i;
7555
 
7556
      if (seg_idx_end == ebb_table->action_count && !ebb->ends_unreachable)
7557
        requires_text_end_align = TRUE;
7558
 
7559
      if (elf32xtensa_size_opt && !requires_text_end_align
7560
          && action->align_type != EBB_REQUIRE_LOOP_ALIGN
7561
          && action->align_type != EBB_REQUIRE_TGT_ALIGN)
7562
        {
7563
          longcall_convert_count = longcall_count;
7564
          narrowable_convert_count = narrowable_count;
7565
          widenable_convert_count = 0;
7566
        }
7567
      else
7568
        {
7569
          /* There is a constraint.  Convert the max number of longcalls.  */
7570
          narrowable_convert_count = 0;
7571
          longcall_convert_count = 0;
7572
          widenable_convert_count = 0;
7573
 
7574
          for (j = 0; j < longcall_count; j++)
7575
            {
7576
              int removed = (longcall_count - j) * 3 & (align - 1);
7577
              unsigned desire_narrow = (align - removed) & (align - 1);
7578
              unsigned desire_widen = removed;
7579
              if (desire_narrow <= narrowable_count)
7580
                {
7581
                  narrowable_convert_count = desire_narrow;
7582
                  narrowable_convert_count +=
7583
                    (align * ((narrowable_count - narrowable_convert_count)
7584
                              / align));
7585
                  longcall_convert_count = (longcall_count - j);
7586
                  widenable_convert_count = 0;
7587
                  break;
7588
                }
7589
              if (desire_widen <= widenable_count && !elf32xtensa_size_opt)
7590
                {
7591
                  narrowable_convert_count = 0;
7592
                  longcall_convert_count = longcall_count - j;
7593
                  widenable_convert_count = desire_widen;
7594
                  break;
7595
                }
7596
            }
7597
        }
7598
 
7599
      /* Now the number of conversions are saved.  Do them.  */
7600
      for (i = seg_idx_start; i < seg_idx_end; i++)
7601
        {
7602
          action = &ebb_table->actions[i];
7603
          switch (action->action)
7604
            {
7605
            case ta_convert_longcall:
7606
              if (longcall_convert_count != 0)
7607
                {
7608
                  action->action = ta_remove_longcall;
7609
                  action->do_action = TRUE;
7610
                  action->removed_bytes += 3;
7611
                  longcall_convert_count--;
7612
                }
7613
              break;
7614
            case ta_narrow_insn:
7615
              if (narrowable_convert_count != 0)
7616
                {
7617
                  action->do_action = TRUE;
7618
                  action->removed_bytes += 1;
7619
                  narrowable_convert_count--;
7620
                }
7621
              break;
7622
            case ta_widen_insn:
7623
              if (widenable_convert_count != 0)
7624
                {
7625
                  action->do_action = TRUE;
7626
                  action->removed_bytes -= 1;
7627
                  widenable_convert_count--;
7628
                }
7629
              break;
7630
            default:
7631
              break;
7632
            }
7633
        }
7634
    }
7635
 
7636
  /* Now we move on to some local opts.  Try to remove each of the
7637
     remaining longcalls.  */
7638
 
7639
  if (ebb_table->ebb.ends_section || ebb_table->ebb.ends_unreachable)
7640
    {
7641
      removed_bytes = 0;
7642
      for (i = 0; i < ebb_table->action_count; i++)
7643
        {
7644
          int old_removed_bytes = removed_bytes;
7645
          proposed_action *action = &ebb_table->actions[i];
7646
 
7647
          if (action->do_action && action->action == ta_convert_longcall)
7648
            {
7649
              bfd_boolean bad_alignment = FALSE;
7650
              removed_bytes += 3;
7651
              for (j = i + 1; j < ebb_table->action_count; j++)
7652
                {
7653
                  proposed_action *new_action = &ebb_table->actions[j];
7654
                  bfd_vma offset = new_action->offset;
7655
                  if (new_action->align_type == EBB_REQUIRE_TGT_ALIGN)
7656
                    {
7657
                      if (!check_branch_target_aligned
7658
                          (ebb_table->ebb.contents,
7659
                           ebb_table->ebb.content_length,
7660
                           offset, offset - removed_bytes))
7661
                        {
7662
                          bad_alignment = TRUE;
7663
                          break;
7664
                        }
7665
                    }
7666
                  if (new_action->align_type == EBB_REQUIRE_LOOP_ALIGN)
7667
                    {
7668
                      if (!check_loop_aligned (ebb_table->ebb.contents,
7669
                                               ebb_table->ebb.content_length,
7670
                                               offset,
7671
                                               offset - removed_bytes))
7672
                        {
7673
                          bad_alignment = TRUE;
7674
                          break;
7675
                        }
7676
                    }
7677
                  if (new_action->action == ta_narrow_insn
7678
                      && !new_action->do_action
7679
                      && ebb_table->ebb.sec->alignment_power == 2)
7680
                    {
7681
                      /* Narrow an instruction and we are done.  */
7682
                      new_action->do_action = TRUE;
7683
                      new_action->removed_bytes += 1;
7684
                      bad_alignment = FALSE;
7685
                      break;
7686
                    }
7687
                  if (new_action->action == ta_widen_insn
7688
                      && new_action->do_action
7689
                      && ebb_table->ebb.sec->alignment_power == 2)
7690
                    {
7691
                      /* Narrow an instruction and we are done.  */
7692
                      new_action->do_action = FALSE;
7693
                      new_action->removed_bytes += 1;
7694
                      bad_alignment = FALSE;
7695
                      break;
7696
                    }
7697
                  if (new_action->do_action)
7698
                    removed_bytes += new_action->removed_bytes;
7699
                }
7700
              if (!bad_alignment)
7701
                {
7702
                  action->removed_bytes += 3;
7703
                  action->action = ta_remove_longcall;
7704
                  action->do_action = TRUE;
7705
                }
7706
            }
7707
          removed_bytes = old_removed_bytes;
7708
          if (action->do_action)
7709
            removed_bytes += action->removed_bytes;
7710
        }
7711
    }
7712
 
7713
  removed_bytes = 0;
7714
  for (i = 0; i < ebb_table->action_count; ++i)
7715
    {
7716
      proposed_action *action = &ebb_table->actions[i];
7717
      if (action->do_action)
7718
        removed_bytes += action->removed_bytes;
7719
    }
7720
 
7721
  if ((removed_bytes % (1 << ebb_table->ebb.sec->alignment_power)) != 0
7722
      && ebb->ends_unreachable)
7723
    {
7724
      proposed_action *action;
7725
      int br;
7726
      int extra_space;
7727
 
7728
      BFD_ASSERT (ebb_table->action_count != 0);
7729
      action = &ebb_table->actions[ebb_table->action_count - 1];
7730
      BFD_ASSERT (action->action == ta_fill);
7731
      BFD_ASSERT (ebb->ends_unreachable->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE);
7732
 
7733
      extra_space = compute_fill_extra_space (ebb->ends_unreachable);
7734
      br = action->removed_bytes + removed_bytes + extra_space;
7735
      br = br & ((1 << ebb->sec->alignment_power ) - 1);
7736
 
7737
      action->removed_bytes = extra_space - br;
7738
    }
7739
  return TRUE;
7740
}
7741
 
7742
 
7743
/* The xlate_map is a sorted array of address mappings designed to
7744
   answer the offset_with_removed_text() query with a binary search instead
7745
   of a linear search through the section's action_list.  */
7746
 
7747
typedef struct xlate_map_entry xlate_map_entry_t;
7748
typedef struct xlate_map xlate_map_t;
7749
 
7750
struct xlate_map_entry
7751
{
7752
  unsigned orig_address;
7753
  unsigned new_address;
7754
  unsigned size;
7755
};
7756
 
7757
struct xlate_map
7758
{
7759
  unsigned entry_count;
7760
  xlate_map_entry_t *entry;
7761
};
7762
 
7763
 
7764
static int
7765
xlate_compare (const void *a_v, const void *b_v)
7766
{
7767
  const xlate_map_entry_t *a = (const xlate_map_entry_t *) a_v;
7768
  const xlate_map_entry_t *b = (const xlate_map_entry_t *) b_v;
7769
  if (a->orig_address < b->orig_address)
7770
    return -1;
7771
  if (a->orig_address > (b->orig_address + b->size - 1))
7772
    return 1;
7773
  return 0;
7774
}
7775
 
7776
 
7777
static bfd_vma
7778
xlate_offset_with_removed_text (const xlate_map_t *map,
7779
                                text_action_list *action_list,
7780
                                bfd_vma offset)
7781
{
7782
  xlate_map_entry_t tmp;
7783
  void *r;
7784
  xlate_map_entry_t *e;
7785
 
7786
  if (map == NULL)
7787
    return offset_with_removed_text (action_list, offset);
7788
 
7789
  if (map->entry_count == 0)
7790
    return offset;
7791
 
7792
  tmp.orig_address = offset;
7793
  tmp.new_address = offset;
7794
  tmp.size = 1;
7795
 
7796
  r = bsearch (&offset, map->entry, map->entry_count,
7797
               sizeof (xlate_map_entry_t), &xlate_compare);
7798
  e = (xlate_map_entry_t *) r;
7799
 
7800
  BFD_ASSERT (e != NULL);
7801
  if (e == NULL)
7802
    return offset;
7803
  return e->new_address - e->orig_address + offset;
7804
}
7805
 
7806
 
7807
/* Build a binary searchable offset translation map from a section's
7808
   action list.  */
7809
 
7810
static xlate_map_t *
7811
build_xlate_map (asection *sec, xtensa_relax_info *relax_info)
7812
{
7813
  xlate_map_t *map = (xlate_map_t *) bfd_malloc (sizeof (xlate_map_t));
7814
  text_action_list *action_list = &relax_info->action_list;
7815
  unsigned num_actions = 0;
7816
  text_action *r;
7817
  int removed;
7818
  xlate_map_entry_t *current_entry;
7819
 
7820
  if (map == NULL)
7821
    return NULL;
7822
 
7823
  num_actions = action_list_count (action_list);
7824
  map->entry = (xlate_map_entry_t *)
7825
    bfd_malloc (sizeof (xlate_map_entry_t) * (num_actions + 1));
7826
  if (map->entry == NULL)
7827
    {
7828
      free (map);
7829
      return NULL;
7830
    }
7831
  map->entry_count = 0;
7832
 
7833
  removed = 0;
7834
  current_entry = &map->entry[0];
7835
 
7836
  current_entry->orig_address = 0;
7837
  current_entry->new_address = 0;
7838
  current_entry->size = 0;
7839
 
7840
  for (r = action_list->head; r != NULL; r = r->next)
7841
    {
7842
      unsigned orig_size = 0;
7843
      switch (r->action)
7844
        {
7845
        case ta_none:
7846
        case ta_remove_insn:
7847
        case ta_convert_longcall:
7848
        case ta_remove_literal:
7849
        case ta_add_literal:
7850
          break;
7851
        case ta_remove_longcall:
7852
          orig_size = 6;
7853
          break;
7854
        case ta_narrow_insn:
7855
          orig_size = 3;
7856
          break;
7857
        case ta_widen_insn:
7858
          orig_size = 2;
7859
          break;
7860
        case ta_fill:
7861
          break;
7862
        }
7863
      current_entry->size =
7864
        r->offset + orig_size - current_entry->orig_address;
7865
      if (current_entry->size != 0)
7866
        {
7867
          current_entry++;
7868
          map->entry_count++;
7869
        }
7870
      current_entry->orig_address = r->offset + orig_size;
7871
      removed += r->removed_bytes;
7872
      current_entry->new_address = r->offset + orig_size - removed;
7873
      current_entry->size = 0;
7874
    }
7875
 
7876
  current_entry->size = (bfd_get_section_limit (sec->owner, sec)
7877
                         - current_entry->orig_address);
7878
  if (current_entry->size != 0)
7879
    map->entry_count++;
7880
 
7881
  return map;
7882
}
7883
 
7884
 
7885
/* Free an offset translation map.  */
7886
 
7887
static void
7888
free_xlate_map (xlate_map_t *map)
7889
{
7890
  if (map && map->entry)
7891
    free (map->entry);
7892
  if (map)
7893
    free (map);
7894
}
7895
 
7896
 
7897
/* Use check_section_ebb_pcrels_fit to make sure that all of the
7898
   relocations in a section will fit if a proposed set of actions
7899
   are performed.  */
7900
 
7901
static bfd_boolean
7902
check_section_ebb_pcrels_fit (bfd *abfd,
7903
                              asection *sec,
7904
                              bfd_byte *contents,
7905
                              Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs,
7906
                              const ebb_constraint *constraint,
7907
                              const xtensa_opcode *reloc_opcodes)
7908
{
7909
  unsigned i, j;
7910
  Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
7911
  xlate_map_t *xmap = NULL;
7912
  bfd_boolean ok = TRUE;
7913
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
7914
 
7915
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
7916
 
7917
  if (relax_info && sec->reloc_count > 100)
7918
    {
7919
      xmap = build_xlate_map (sec, relax_info);
7920
      /* NULL indicates out of memory, but the slow version
7921
         can still be used.  */
7922
    }
7923
 
7924
  for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
7925
    {
7926
      r_reloc r_rel;
7927
      bfd_vma orig_self_offset, orig_target_offset;
7928
      bfd_vma self_offset, target_offset;
7929
      int r_type;
7930
      reloc_howto_type *howto;
7931
      int self_removed_bytes, target_removed_bytes;
7932
 
7933
      irel = &internal_relocs[i];
7934
      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
7935
 
7936
      howto = &elf_howto_table[r_type];
7937
      /* We maintain the required invariant: PC-relative relocations
7938
         that fit before linking must fit after linking.  Thus we only
7939
         need to deal with relocations to the same section that are
7940
         PC-relative.  */
7941
      if (r_type == R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY
7942
          || r_type == R_XTENSA_32_PCREL
7943
          || !howto->pc_relative)
7944
        continue;
7945
 
7946
      r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents,
7947
                    bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec));
7948
 
7949
      if (r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel) != sec)
7950
        continue;
7951
 
7952
      orig_self_offset = irel->r_offset;
7953
      orig_target_offset = r_rel.target_offset;
7954
 
7955
      self_offset = orig_self_offset;
7956
      target_offset = orig_target_offset;
7957
 
7958
      if (relax_info)
7959
        {
7960
          self_offset =
7961
            xlate_offset_with_removed_text (xmap, &relax_info->action_list,
7962
                                            orig_self_offset);
7963
          target_offset =
7964
            xlate_offset_with_removed_text (xmap, &relax_info->action_list,
7965
                                            orig_target_offset);
7966
        }
7967
 
7968
      self_removed_bytes = 0;
7969
      target_removed_bytes = 0;
7970
 
7971
      for (j = 0; j < constraint->action_count; ++j)
7972
        {
7973
          proposed_action *action = &constraint->actions[j];
7974
          bfd_vma offset = action->offset;
7975
          int removed_bytes = action->removed_bytes;
7976
          if (offset < orig_self_offset
7977
              || (offset == orig_self_offset && action->action == ta_fill
7978
                  && action->removed_bytes < 0))
7979
            self_removed_bytes += removed_bytes;
7980
          if (offset < orig_target_offset
7981
              || (offset == orig_target_offset && action->action == ta_fill
7982
                  && action->removed_bytes < 0))
7983
            target_removed_bytes += removed_bytes;
7984
        }
7985
      self_offset -= self_removed_bytes;
7986
      target_offset -= target_removed_bytes;
7987
 
7988
      /* Try to encode it.  Get the operand and check.  */
7989
      if (is_alt_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info)))
7990
        {
7991
          /* None of the current alternate relocs are PC-relative,
7992
             and only PC-relative relocs matter here.  */
7993
        }
7994
      else
7995
        {
7996
          xtensa_opcode opcode;
7997
          int opnum;
7998
 
7999
          if (reloc_opcodes)
8000
            opcode = reloc_opcodes[i];
8001
          else
8002
            opcode = get_relocation_opcode (abfd, sec, contents, irel);
8003
          if (opcode == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
8004
            {
8005
              ok = FALSE;
8006
              break;
8007
            }
8008
 
8009
          opnum = get_relocation_opnd (opcode, ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info));
8010
          if (opnum == XTENSA_UNDEFINED)
8011
            {
8012
              ok = FALSE;
8013
              break;
8014
            }
8015
 
8016
          if (!pcrel_reloc_fits (opcode, opnum, self_offset, target_offset))
8017
            {
8018
              ok = FALSE;
8019
              break;
8020
            }
8021
        }
8022
    }
8023
 
8024
  if (xmap)
8025
    free_xlate_map (xmap);
8026
 
8027
  return ok;
8028
}
8029
 
8030
 
8031
static bfd_boolean
8032
check_section_ebb_reduces (const ebb_constraint *constraint)
8033
{
8034
  int removed = 0;
8035
  unsigned i;
8036
 
8037
  for (i = 0; i < constraint->action_count; i++)
8038
    {
8039
      const proposed_action *action = &constraint->actions[i];
8040
      if (action->do_action)
8041
        removed += action->removed_bytes;
8042
    }
8043
  if (removed < 0)
8044
    return FALSE;
8045
 
8046
  return TRUE;
8047
}
8048
 
8049
 
8050
void
8051
text_action_add_proposed (text_action_list *l,
8052
                          const ebb_constraint *ebb_table,
8053
                          asection *sec)
8054
{
8055
  unsigned i;
8056
 
8057
  for (i = 0; i < ebb_table->action_count; i++)
8058
    {
8059
      proposed_action *action = &ebb_table->actions[i];
8060
 
8061
      if (!action->do_action)
8062
        continue;
8063
      switch (action->action)
8064
        {
8065
        case ta_remove_insn:
8066
        case ta_remove_longcall:
8067
        case ta_convert_longcall:
8068
        case ta_narrow_insn:
8069
        case ta_widen_insn:
8070
        case ta_fill:
8071
        case ta_remove_literal:
8072
          text_action_add (l, action->action, sec, action->offset,
8073
                           action->removed_bytes);
8074
          break;
8075
        case ta_none:
8076
          break;
8077
        default:
8078
          BFD_ASSERT (0);
8079
          break;
8080
        }
8081
    }
8082
}
8083
 
8084
 
8085
int
8086
compute_fill_extra_space (property_table_entry *entry)
8087
{
8088
  int fill_extra_space;
8089
 
8090
  if (!entry)
8091
    return 0;
8092
 
8093
  if ((entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE) == 0)
8094
    return 0;
8095
 
8096
  fill_extra_space = entry->size;
8097
  if ((entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN) != 0)
8098
    {
8099
      /* Fill bytes for alignment:
8100
         (2**n)-1 - (addr + (2**n)-1) & (2**n -1) */
8101
      int pow = GET_XTENSA_PROP_ALIGNMENT (entry->flags);
8102
      int nsm = (1 << pow) - 1;
8103
      bfd_vma addr = entry->address + entry->size;
8104
      bfd_vma align_fill = nsm - ((addr + nsm) & nsm);
8105
      fill_extra_space += align_fill;
8106
    }
8107
  return fill_extra_space;
8108
}
8109
 
8110
 
8111
/* First relaxation pass.  */
8112
 
8113
/* If the section contains relaxable literals, check each literal to
8114
   see if it has the same value as another literal that has already
8115
   been seen, either in the current section or a previous one.  If so,
8116
   add an entry to the per-section list of removed literals.  The
8117
   actual changes are deferred until the next pass.  */
8118
 
8119
static bfd_boolean
8120
compute_removed_literals (bfd *abfd,
8121
                          asection *sec,
8122
                          struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
8123
                          value_map_hash_table *values)
8124
{
8125
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
8126
  bfd_byte *contents;
8127
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
8128
  source_reloc *src_relocs, *rel;
8129
  bfd_boolean ok = TRUE;
8130
  property_table_entry *prop_table = NULL;
8131
  int ptblsize;
8132
  int i, prev_i;
8133
  bfd_boolean last_loc_is_prev = FALSE;
8134
  bfd_vma last_target_offset = 0;
8135
  section_cache_t target_sec_cache;
8136
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
8137
 
8138
  init_section_cache (&target_sec_cache);
8139
 
8140
  /* Do nothing if it is not a relaxable literal section.  */
8141
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
8142
  BFD_ASSERT (relax_info);
8143
  if (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section)
8144
    return ok;
8145
 
8146
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
8147
                                              link_info->keep_memory);
8148
 
8149
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
8150
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
8151
  if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
8152
    {
8153
      ok = FALSE;
8154
      goto error_return;
8155
    }
8156
 
8157
  /* Sort the source_relocs by target offset.  */
8158
  src_relocs = relax_info->src_relocs;
8159
  qsort (src_relocs, relax_info->src_count,
8160
         sizeof (source_reloc), source_reloc_compare);
8161
  qsort (internal_relocs, sec->reloc_count, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela),
8162
         internal_reloc_compare);
8163
 
8164
  ptblsize = xtensa_read_table_entries (abfd, sec, &prop_table,
8165
                                        XTENSA_PROP_SEC_NAME, FALSE);
8166
  if (ptblsize < 0)
8167
    {
8168
      ok = FALSE;
8169
      goto error_return;
8170
    }
8171
 
8172
  prev_i = -1;
8173
  for (i = 0; i < relax_info->src_count; i++)
8174
    {
8175
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = NULL;
8176
 
8177
      rel = &src_relocs[i];
8178
      if (get_l32r_opcode () != rel->opcode)
8179
        continue;
8180
      irel = get_irel_at_offset (sec, internal_relocs,
8181
                                 rel->r_rel.target_offset);
8182
 
8183
      /* If the relocation on this is not a simple R_XTENSA_32 or
8184
         R_XTENSA_PLT then do not consider it.  This may happen when
8185
         the difference of two symbols is used in a literal.  */
8186
      if (irel && (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_32
8187
                   && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_PLT))
8188
        continue;
8189
 
8190
      /* If the target_offset for this relocation is the same as the
8191
         previous relocation, then we've already considered whether the
8192
         literal can be coalesced.  Skip to the next one....  */
8193
      if (i != 0 && prev_i != -1
8194
          && src_relocs[i-1].r_rel.target_offset == rel->r_rel.target_offset)
8195
        continue;
8196
      prev_i = i;
8197
 
8198
      if (last_loc_is_prev &&
8199
          last_target_offset + 4 != rel->r_rel.target_offset)
8200
        last_loc_is_prev = FALSE;
8201
 
8202
      /* Check if the relocation was from an L32R that is being removed
8203
         because a CALLX was converted to a direct CALL, and check if
8204
         there are no other relocations to the literal.  */
8205
      if (is_removable_literal (rel, i, src_relocs, relax_info->src_count,
8206
                                sec, prop_table, ptblsize))
8207
        {
8208
          if (!remove_dead_literal (abfd, sec, link_info, internal_relocs,
8209
                                    irel, rel, prop_table, ptblsize))
8210
            {
8211
              ok = FALSE;
8212
              goto error_return;
8213
            }
8214
          last_target_offset = rel->r_rel.target_offset;
8215
          continue;
8216
        }
8217
 
8218
      if (!identify_literal_placement (abfd, sec, contents, link_info,
8219
                                       values,
8220
                                       &last_loc_is_prev, irel,
8221
                                       relax_info->src_count - i, rel,
8222
                                       prop_table, ptblsize,
8223
                                       &target_sec_cache, rel->is_abs_literal))
8224
        {
8225
          ok = FALSE;
8226
          goto error_return;
8227
        }
8228
      last_target_offset = rel->r_rel.target_offset;
8229
    }
8230
 
8231
#if DEBUG
8232
  print_removed_literals (stderr, &relax_info->removed_list);
8233
  print_action_list (stderr, &relax_info->action_list);
8234
#endif /* DEBUG */
8235
 
8236
error_return:
8237
  if (prop_table) free (prop_table);
8238
  clear_section_cache (&target_sec_cache);
8239
 
8240
  release_contents (sec, contents);
8241
  release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
8242
  return ok;
8243
}
8244
 
8245
 
8246
static Elf_Internal_Rela *
8247
get_irel_at_offset (asection *sec,
8248
                    Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs,
8249
                    bfd_vma offset)
8250
{
8251
  unsigned i;
8252
  Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
8253
  unsigned r_type;
8254
  Elf_Internal_Rela key;
8255
 
8256
  if (!internal_relocs)
8257
    return NULL;
8258
 
8259
  key.r_offset = offset;
8260
  irel = bsearch (&key, internal_relocs, sec->reloc_count,
8261
                  sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela), internal_reloc_matches);
8262
  if (!irel)
8263
    return NULL;
8264
 
8265
  /* bsearch does not guarantee which will be returned if there are
8266
     multiple matches.  We need the first that is not an alignment.  */
8267
  i = irel - internal_relocs;
8268
  while (i > 0)
8269
    {
8270
      if (internal_relocs[i-1].r_offset != offset)
8271
        break;
8272
      i--;
8273
    }
8274
  for ( ; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
8275
    {
8276
      irel = &internal_relocs[i];
8277
      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
8278
      if (irel->r_offset == offset && r_type != R_XTENSA_NONE)
8279
        return irel;
8280
    }
8281
 
8282
  return NULL;
8283
}
8284
 
8285
 
8286
bfd_boolean
8287
is_removable_literal (const source_reloc *rel,
8288
                      int i,
8289
                      const source_reloc *src_relocs,
8290
                      int src_count,
8291
                      asection *sec,
8292
                      property_table_entry *prop_table,
8293
                      int ptblsize)
8294
{
8295
  const source_reloc *curr_rel;
8296
  property_table_entry *entry;
8297
 
8298
  if (!rel->is_null)
8299
    return FALSE;
8300
 
8301
  entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
8302
                                          sec->vma + rel->r_rel.target_offset);
8303
  if (entry && (entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM))
8304
    return FALSE;
8305
 
8306
  for (++i; i < src_count; ++i)
8307
    {
8308
      curr_rel = &src_relocs[i];
8309
      /* If all others have the same target offset....  */
8310
      if (curr_rel->r_rel.target_offset != rel->r_rel.target_offset)
8311
        return TRUE;
8312
 
8313
      if (!curr_rel->is_null
8314
          && !xtensa_is_property_section (curr_rel->source_sec)
8315
          && !(curr_rel->source_sec->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
8316
        return FALSE;
8317
    }
8318
  return TRUE;
8319
}
8320
 
8321
 
8322
bfd_boolean
8323
remove_dead_literal (bfd *abfd,
8324
                     asection *sec,
8325
                     struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
8326
                     Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs,
8327
                     Elf_Internal_Rela *irel,
8328
                     source_reloc *rel,
8329
                     property_table_entry *prop_table,
8330
                     int ptblsize)
8331
{
8332
  property_table_entry *entry;
8333
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
8334
 
8335
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
8336
  if (!relax_info)
8337
    return FALSE;
8338
 
8339
  entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
8340
                                          sec->vma + rel->r_rel.target_offset);
8341
 
8342
  /* Mark the unused literal so that it will be removed.  */
8343
  add_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list, &rel->r_rel, NULL);
8344
 
8345
  text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
8346
                   ta_remove_literal, sec, rel->r_rel.target_offset, 4);
8347
 
8348
  /* If the section is 4-byte aligned, do not add fill.  */
8349
  if (sec->alignment_power > 2)
8350
    {
8351
      int fill_extra_space;
8352
      bfd_vma entry_sec_offset;
8353
      text_action *fa;
8354
      property_table_entry *the_add_entry;
8355
      int removed_diff;
8356
 
8357
      if (entry)
8358
        entry_sec_offset = entry->address - sec->vma + entry->size;
8359
      else
8360
        entry_sec_offset = rel->r_rel.target_offset + 4;
8361
 
8362
      /* If the literal range is at the end of the section,
8363
         do not add fill.  */
8364
      the_add_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
8365
                                                      entry_sec_offset);
8366
      fill_extra_space = compute_fill_extra_space (the_add_entry);
8367
 
8368
      fa = find_fill_action (&relax_info->action_list, sec, entry_sec_offset);
8369
      removed_diff = compute_removed_action_diff (fa, sec, entry_sec_offset,
8370
                                                  -4, fill_extra_space);
8371
      if (fa)
8372
        adjust_fill_action (fa, removed_diff);
8373
      else
8374
        text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
8375
                         ta_fill, sec, entry_sec_offset, removed_diff);
8376
    }
8377
 
8378
  /* Zero out the relocation on this literal location.  */
8379
  if (irel)
8380
    {
8381
      if (elf_hash_table (link_info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8382
        shrink_dynamic_reloc_sections (link_info, abfd, sec, irel);
8383
 
8384
      irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
8385
      pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
8386
    }
8387
 
8388
  /* Do not modify "last_loc_is_prev".  */
8389
  return TRUE;
8390
}
8391
 
8392
 
8393
bfd_boolean
8394
identify_literal_placement (bfd *abfd,
8395
                            asection *sec,
8396
                            bfd_byte *contents,
8397
                            struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
8398
                            value_map_hash_table *values,
8399
                            bfd_boolean *last_loc_is_prev_p,
8400
                            Elf_Internal_Rela *irel,
8401
                            int remaining_src_rels,
8402
                            source_reloc *rel,
8403
                            property_table_entry *prop_table,
8404
                            int ptblsize,
8405
                            section_cache_t *target_sec_cache,
8406
                            bfd_boolean is_abs_literal)
8407
{
8408
  literal_value val;
8409
  value_map *val_map;
8410
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
8411
  bfd_boolean literal_placed = FALSE;
8412
  r_reloc r_rel;
8413
  unsigned long value;
8414
  bfd_boolean final_static_link;
8415
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
8416
 
8417
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
8418
  if (!relax_info)
8419
    return FALSE;
8420
 
8421
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
8422
 
8423
  final_static_link =
8424
    (!link_info->relocatable
8425
     && !elf_hash_table (link_info)->dynamic_sections_created);
8426
 
8427
  /* The placement algorithm first checks to see if the literal is
8428
     already in the value map.  If so and the value map is reachable
8429
     from all uses, then the literal is moved to that location.  If
8430
     not, then we identify the last location where a fresh literal was
8431
     placed.  If the literal can be safely moved there, then we do so.
8432
     If not, then we assume that the literal is not to move and leave
8433
     the literal where it is, marking it as the last literal
8434
     location.  */
8435
 
8436
  /* Find the literal value.  */
8437
  value = 0;
8438
  r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
8439
  if (!irel)
8440
    {
8441
      BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_rel.target_offset < sec_size);
8442
      value = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + rel->r_rel.target_offset);
8443
    }
8444
  init_literal_value (&val, &r_rel, value, is_abs_literal);
8445
 
8446
  /* Check if we've seen another literal with the same value that
8447
     is in the same output section.  */
8448
  val_map = value_map_get_cached_value (values, &val, final_static_link);
8449
 
8450
  if (val_map
8451
      && (r_reloc_get_section (&val_map->loc)->output_section
8452
          == sec->output_section)
8453
      && relocations_reach (rel, remaining_src_rels, &val_map->loc)
8454
      && coalesce_shared_literal (sec, rel, prop_table, ptblsize, val_map))
8455
    {
8456
      /* No change to last_loc_is_prev.  */
8457
      literal_placed = TRUE;
8458
    }
8459
 
8460
  /* For relocatable links, do not try to move literals.  To do it
8461
     correctly might increase the number of relocations in an input
8462
     section making the default relocatable linking fail.  */
8463
  if (!link_info->relocatable && !literal_placed
8464
      && values->has_last_loc && !(*last_loc_is_prev_p))
8465
    {
8466
      asection *target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&values->last_loc);
8467
      if (target_sec && target_sec->output_section == sec->output_section)
8468
        {
8469
          /* Increment the virtual offset.  */
8470
          r_reloc try_loc = values->last_loc;
8471
          try_loc.virtual_offset += 4;
8472
 
8473
          /* There is a last loc that was in the same output section.  */
8474
          if (relocations_reach (rel, remaining_src_rels, &try_loc)
8475
              && move_shared_literal (sec, link_info, rel,
8476
                                      prop_table, ptblsize,
8477
                                      &try_loc, &val, target_sec_cache))
8478
            {
8479
              values->last_loc.virtual_offset += 4;
8480
              literal_placed = TRUE;
8481
              if (!val_map)
8482
                val_map = add_value_map (values, &val, &try_loc,
8483
                                         final_static_link);
8484
              else
8485
                val_map->loc = try_loc;
8486
            }
8487
        }
8488
    }
8489
 
8490
  if (!literal_placed)
8491
    {
8492
      /* Nothing worked, leave the literal alone but update the last loc.  */
8493
      values->has_last_loc = TRUE;
8494
      values->last_loc = rel->r_rel;
8495
      if (!val_map)
8496
        val_map = add_value_map (values, &val, &rel->r_rel, final_static_link);
8497
      else
8498
        val_map->loc = rel->r_rel;
8499
      *last_loc_is_prev_p = TRUE;
8500
    }
8501
 
8502
  return TRUE;
8503
}
8504
 
8505
 
8506
/* Check if the original relocations (presumably on L32R instructions)
8507
   identified by reloc[0..N] can be changed to reference the literal
8508
   identified by r_rel.  If r_rel is out of range for any of the
8509
   original relocations, then we don't want to coalesce the original
8510
   literal with the one at r_rel.  We only check reloc[0..N], where the
8511
   offsets are all the same as for reloc[0] (i.e., they're all
8512
   referencing the same literal) and where N is also bounded by the
8513
   number of remaining entries in the "reloc" array.  The "reloc" array
8514
   is sorted by target offset so we know all the entries for the same
8515
   literal will be contiguous.  */
8516
 
8517
static bfd_boolean
8518
relocations_reach (source_reloc *reloc,
8519
                   int remaining_relocs,
8520
                   const r_reloc *r_rel)
8521
{
8522
  bfd_vma from_offset, source_address, dest_address;
8523
  asection *sec;
8524
  int i;
8525
 
8526
  if (!r_reloc_is_defined (r_rel))
8527
    return FALSE;
8528
 
8529
  sec = r_reloc_get_section (r_rel);
8530
  from_offset = reloc[0].r_rel.target_offset;
8531
 
8532
  for (i = 0; i < remaining_relocs; i++)
8533
    {
8534
      if (reloc[i].r_rel.target_offset != from_offset)
8535
        break;
8536
 
8537
      /* Ignore relocations that have been removed.  */
8538
      if (reloc[i].is_null)
8539
        continue;
8540
 
8541
      /* The original and new output section for these must be the same
8542
         in order to coalesce.  */
8543
      if (r_reloc_get_section (&reloc[i].r_rel)->output_section
8544
          != sec->output_section)
8545
        return FALSE;
8546
 
8547
      /* Absolute literals in the same output section can always be
8548
         combined.  */
8549
      if (reloc[i].is_abs_literal)
8550
        continue;
8551
 
8552
      /* A literal with no PC-relative relocations can be moved anywhere.  */
8553
      if (reloc[i].opnd != -1)
8554
        {
8555
          /* Otherwise, check to see that it fits.  */
8556
          source_address = (reloc[i].source_sec->output_section->vma
8557
                            + reloc[i].source_sec->output_offset
8558
                            + reloc[i].r_rel.rela.r_offset);
8559
          dest_address = (sec->output_section->vma
8560
                          + sec->output_offset
8561
                          + r_rel->target_offset);
8562
 
8563
          if (!pcrel_reloc_fits (reloc[i].opcode, reloc[i].opnd,
8564
                                 source_address, dest_address))
8565
            return FALSE;
8566
        }
8567
    }
8568
 
8569
  return TRUE;
8570
}
8571
 
8572
 
8573
/* Move a literal to another literal location because it is
8574
   the same as the other literal value.  */
8575
 
8576
static bfd_boolean
8577
coalesce_shared_literal (asection *sec,
8578
                         source_reloc *rel,
8579
                         property_table_entry *prop_table,
8580
                         int ptblsize,
8581
                         value_map *val_map)
8582
{
8583
  property_table_entry *entry;
8584
  text_action *fa;
8585
  property_table_entry *the_add_entry;
8586
  int removed_diff;
8587
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
8588
 
8589
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
8590
  if (!relax_info)
8591
    return FALSE;
8592
 
8593
  entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry
8594
    (prop_table, ptblsize, sec->vma + rel->r_rel.target_offset);
8595
  if (entry && (entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM))
8596
    return TRUE;
8597
 
8598
  /* Mark that the literal will be coalesced.  */
8599
  add_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list, &rel->r_rel, &val_map->loc);
8600
 
8601
  text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
8602
                   ta_remove_literal, sec, rel->r_rel.target_offset, 4);
8603
 
8604
  /* If the section is 4-byte aligned, do not add fill.  */
8605
  if (sec->alignment_power > 2)
8606
    {
8607
      int fill_extra_space;
8608
      bfd_vma entry_sec_offset;
8609
 
8610
      if (entry)
8611
        entry_sec_offset = entry->address - sec->vma + entry->size;
8612
      else
8613
        entry_sec_offset = rel->r_rel.target_offset + 4;
8614
 
8615
      /* If the literal range is at the end of the section,
8616
         do not add fill.  */
8617
      fill_extra_space = 0;
8618
      the_add_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
8619
                                                      entry_sec_offset);
8620
      if (the_add_entry && (the_add_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE))
8621
        fill_extra_space = the_add_entry->size;
8622
 
8623
      fa = find_fill_action (&relax_info->action_list, sec, entry_sec_offset);
8624
      removed_diff = compute_removed_action_diff (fa, sec, entry_sec_offset,
8625
                                                  -4, fill_extra_space);
8626
      if (fa)
8627
        adjust_fill_action (fa, removed_diff);
8628
      else
8629
        text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
8630
                         ta_fill, sec, entry_sec_offset, removed_diff);
8631
    }
8632
 
8633
  return TRUE;
8634
}
8635
 
8636
 
8637
/* Move a literal to another location.  This may actually increase the
8638
   total amount of space used because of alignments so we need to do
8639
   this carefully.  Also, it may make a branch go out of range.  */
8640
 
8641
static bfd_boolean
8642
move_shared_literal (asection *sec,
8643
                     struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
8644
                     source_reloc *rel,
8645
                     property_table_entry *prop_table,
8646
                     int ptblsize,
8647
                     const r_reloc *target_loc,
8648
                     const literal_value *lit_value,
8649
                     section_cache_t *target_sec_cache)
8650
{
8651
  property_table_entry *the_add_entry, *src_entry, *target_entry = NULL;
8652
  text_action *fa, *target_fa;
8653
  int removed_diff;
8654
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info, *target_relax_info;
8655
  asection *target_sec;
8656
  ebb_t *ebb;
8657
  ebb_constraint ebb_table;
8658
  bfd_boolean relocs_fit;
8659
 
8660
  /* If this routine always returns FALSE, the literals that cannot be
8661
     coalesced will not be moved.  */
8662
  if (elf32xtensa_no_literal_movement)
8663
    return FALSE;
8664
 
8665
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
8666
  if (!relax_info)
8667
    return FALSE;
8668
 
8669
  target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (target_loc);
8670
  target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
8671
 
8672
  /* Literals to undefined sections may not be moved because they
8673
     must report an error.  */
8674
  if (bfd_is_und_section (target_sec))
8675
    return FALSE;
8676
 
8677
  src_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry
8678
    (prop_table, ptblsize, sec->vma + rel->r_rel.target_offset);
8679
 
8680
  if (!section_cache_section (target_sec_cache, target_sec, link_info))
8681
    return FALSE;
8682
 
8683
  target_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry
8684
    (target_sec_cache->ptbl, target_sec_cache->pte_count,
8685
     target_sec->vma + target_loc->target_offset);
8686
 
8687
  if (!target_entry)
8688
    return FALSE;
8689
 
8690
  /* Make sure that we have not broken any branches.  */
8691
  relocs_fit = FALSE;
8692
 
8693
  init_ebb_constraint (&ebb_table);
8694
  ebb = &ebb_table.ebb;
8695
  init_ebb (ebb, target_sec_cache->sec, target_sec_cache->contents,
8696
            target_sec_cache->content_length,
8697
            target_sec_cache->ptbl, target_sec_cache->pte_count,
8698
            target_sec_cache->relocs, target_sec_cache->reloc_count);
8699
 
8700
  /* Propose to add 4 bytes + worst-case alignment size increase to
8701
     destination.  */
8702
  ebb_propose_action (&ebb_table, EBB_NO_ALIGN, 0,
8703
                      ta_fill, target_loc->target_offset,
8704
                      -4 - (1 << target_sec->alignment_power), TRUE);
8705
 
8706
  /* Check all of the PC-relative relocations to make sure they still fit.  */
8707
  relocs_fit = check_section_ebb_pcrels_fit (target_sec->owner, target_sec,
8708
                                             target_sec_cache->contents,
8709
                                             target_sec_cache->relocs,
8710
                                             &ebb_table, NULL);
8711
 
8712
  if (!relocs_fit)
8713
    return FALSE;
8714
 
8715
  text_action_add_literal (&target_relax_info->action_list,
8716
                           ta_add_literal, target_loc, lit_value, -4);
8717
 
8718
  if (target_sec->alignment_power > 2 && target_entry != src_entry)
8719
    {
8720
      /* May need to add or remove some fill to maintain alignment.  */
8721
      int fill_extra_space;
8722
      bfd_vma entry_sec_offset;
8723
 
8724
      entry_sec_offset =
8725
        target_entry->address - target_sec->vma + target_entry->size;
8726
 
8727
      /* If the literal range is at the end of the section,
8728
         do not add fill.  */
8729
      fill_extra_space = 0;
8730
      the_add_entry =
8731
        elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (target_sec_cache->ptbl,
8732
                                        target_sec_cache->pte_count,
8733
                                        entry_sec_offset);
8734
      if (the_add_entry && (the_add_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE))
8735
        fill_extra_space = the_add_entry->size;
8736
 
8737
      target_fa = find_fill_action (&target_relax_info->action_list,
8738
                                    target_sec, entry_sec_offset);
8739
      removed_diff = compute_removed_action_diff (target_fa, target_sec,
8740
                                                  entry_sec_offset, 4,
8741
                                                  fill_extra_space);
8742
      if (target_fa)
8743
        adjust_fill_action (target_fa, removed_diff);
8744
      else
8745
        text_action_add (&target_relax_info->action_list,
8746
                         ta_fill, target_sec, entry_sec_offset, removed_diff);
8747
    }
8748
 
8749
  /* Mark that the literal will be moved to the new location.  */
8750
  add_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list, &rel->r_rel, target_loc);
8751
 
8752
  /* Remove the literal.  */
8753
  text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
8754
                   ta_remove_literal, sec, rel->r_rel.target_offset, 4);
8755
 
8756
  /* If the section is 4-byte aligned, do not add fill.  */
8757
  if (sec->alignment_power > 2 && target_entry != src_entry)
8758
    {
8759
      int fill_extra_space;
8760
      bfd_vma entry_sec_offset;
8761
 
8762
      if (src_entry)
8763
        entry_sec_offset = src_entry->address - sec->vma + src_entry->size;
8764
      else
8765
        entry_sec_offset = rel->r_rel.target_offset+4;
8766
 
8767
      /* If the literal range is at the end of the section,
8768
         do not add fill.  */
8769
      fill_extra_space = 0;
8770
      the_add_entry = elf_xtensa_find_property_entry (prop_table, ptblsize,
8771
                                                      entry_sec_offset);
8772
      if (the_add_entry && (the_add_entry->flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE))
8773
        fill_extra_space = the_add_entry->size;
8774
 
8775
      fa = find_fill_action (&relax_info->action_list, sec, entry_sec_offset);
8776
      removed_diff = compute_removed_action_diff (fa, sec, entry_sec_offset,
8777
                                                  -4, fill_extra_space);
8778
      if (fa)
8779
        adjust_fill_action (fa, removed_diff);
8780
      else
8781
        text_action_add (&relax_info->action_list,
8782
                         ta_fill, sec, entry_sec_offset, removed_diff);
8783
    }
8784
 
8785
  return TRUE;
8786
}
8787
 
8788
 
8789
/* Second relaxation pass.  */
8790
 
8791
/* Modify all of the relocations to point to the right spot, and if this
8792
   is a relaxable section, delete the unwanted literals and fix the
8793
   section size.  */
8794
 
8795
bfd_boolean
8796
relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
8797
{
8798
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
8799
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
8800
  bfd_byte *contents;
8801
  bfd_boolean ok = TRUE;
8802
  unsigned i;
8803
  bfd_boolean rv = FALSE;
8804
  bfd_boolean virtual_action;
8805
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
8806
 
8807
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
8808
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
8809
  BFD_ASSERT (relax_info);
8810
 
8811
  /* First translate any of the fixes that have been added already.  */
8812
  translate_section_fixes (sec);
8813
 
8814
  /* Handle property sections (e.g., literal tables) specially.  */
8815
  if (xtensa_is_property_section (sec))
8816
    {
8817
      BFD_ASSERT (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section);
8818
      return relax_property_section (abfd, sec, link_info);
8819
    }
8820
 
8821
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
8822
                                              link_info->keep_memory);
8823
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
8824
  if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
8825
    {
8826
      ok = FALSE;
8827
      goto error_return;
8828
    }
8829
 
8830
  if (internal_relocs)
8831
    {
8832
      for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
8833
        {
8834
          Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
8835
          xtensa_relax_info *target_relax_info;
8836
          bfd_vma source_offset, old_source_offset;
8837
          r_reloc r_rel;
8838
          unsigned r_type;
8839
          asection *target_sec;
8840
 
8841
          /* Locally change the source address.
8842
             Translate the target to the new target address.
8843
             If it points to this section and has been removed,
8844
             NULLify it.
8845
             Write it back.  */
8846
 
8847
          irel = &internal_relocs[i];
8848
          source_offset = irel->r_offset;
8849
          old_source_offset = source_offset;
8850
 
8851
          r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
8852
          r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents,
8853
                        bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec));
8854
 
8855
          /* If this section could have changed then we may need to
8856
             change the relocation's offset.  */
8857
 
8858
          if (relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
8859
              || relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
8860
            {
8861
              pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
8862
 
8863
              if (r_type != R_XTENSA_NONE
8864
                  && find_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list,
8865
                                           irel->r_offset))
8866
                {
8867
                  /* Remove this relocation.  */
8868
                  if (elf_hash_table (link_info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8869
                    shrink_dynamic_reloc_sections (link_info, abfd, sec, irel);
8870
                  irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
8871
                  irel->r_offset = offset_with_removed_text
8872
                    (&relax_info->action_list, irel->r_offset);
8873
                  continue;
8874
                }
8875
 
8876
              if (r_type == R_XTENSA_ASM_SIMPLIFY)
8877
                {
8878
                  text_action *action =
8879
                    find_insn_action (&relax_info->action_list,
8880
                                      irel->r_offset);
8881
                  if (action && (action->action == ta_convert_longcall
8882
                                 || action->action == ta_remove_longcall))
8883
                    {
8884
                      bfd_reloc_status_type retval;
8885
                      char *error_message = NULL;
8886
 
8887
                      retval = contract_asm_expansion (contents, sec_size,
8888
                                                       irel, &error_message);
8889
                      if (retval != bfd_reloc_ok)
8890
                        {
8891
                          (*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
8892
                            (link_info, error_message, abfd, sec,
8893
                             irel->r_offset);
8894
                          goto error_return;
8895
                        }
8896
                      /* Update the action so that the code that moves
8897
                         the contents will do the right thing.  */
8898
                      if (action->action == ta_remove_longcall)
8899
                        action->action = ta_remove_insn;
8900
                      else
8901
                        action->action = ta_none;
8902
                      /* Refresh the info in the r_rel.  */
8903
                      r_reloc_init (&r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
8904
                      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
8905
                    }
8906
                }
8907
 
8908
              source_offset = offset_with_removed_text
8909
                (&relax_info->action_list, irel->r_offset);
8910
              irel->r_offset = source_offset;
8911
            }
8912
 
8913
          /* If the target section could have changed then
8914
             we may need to change the relocation's target offset.  */
8915
 
8916
          target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
8917
 
8918
          /* For a reference to a discarded section from a DWARF section,
8919
             i.e., where action_discarded is PRETEND, the symbol will
8920
             eventually be modified to refer to the kept section (at least if
8921
             the kept and discarded sections are the same size).  Anticipate
8922
             that here and adjust things accordingly.  */
8923
          if (! elf_xtensa_ignore_discarded_relocs (sec)
8924
              && elf_xtensa_action_discarded (sec) == PRETEND
8925
              && sec->sec_info_type != ELF_INFO_TYPE_STABS
8926
              && target_sec != NULL
8927
              && elf_discarded_section (target_sec))
8928
            {
8929
              /* It would be natural to call _bfd_elf_check_kept_section
8930
                 here, but it's not exported from elflink.c.  It's also a
8931
                 fairly expensive check.  Adjusting the relocations to the
8932
                 discarded section is fairly harmless; it will only adjust
8933
                 some addends and difference values.  If it turns out that
8934
                 _bfd_elf_check_kept_section fails later, it won't matter,
8935
                 so just compare the section names to find the right group
8936
                 member.  */
8937
              asection *kept = target_sec->kept_section;
8938
              if (kept != NULL)
8939
                {
8940
                  if ((kept->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
8941
                    {
8942
                      asection *first = elf_next_in_group (kept);
8943
                      asection *s = first;
8944
 
8945
                      kept = NULL;
8946
                      while (s != NULL)
8947
                        {
8948
                          if (strcmp (s->name, target_sec->name) == 0)
8949
                            {
8950
                              kept = s;
8951
                              break;
8952
                            }
8953
                          s = elf_next_in_group (s);
8954
                          if (s == first)
8955
                            break;
8956
                        }
8957
                    }
8958
                }
8959
              if (kept != NULL
8960
                  && ((target_sec->rawsize != 0
8961
                       ? target_sec->rawsize : target_sec->size)
8962
                      == (kept->rawsize != 0 ? kept->rawsize : kept->size)))
8963
                target_sec = kept;
8964
            }
8965
 
8966
          target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
8967
          if (target_relax_info
8968
              && (target_relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
8969
                  || target_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section))
8970
            {
8971
              r_reloc new_reloc;
8972
              target_sec = translate_reloc (&r_rel, &new_reloc, target_sec);
8973
 
8974
              if (r_type == R_XTENSA_DIFF8
8975
                  || r_type == R_XTENSA_DIFF16
8976
                  || r_type == R_XTENSA_DIFF32)
8977
                {
8978
                  bfd_vma diff_value = 0, new_end_offset, diff_mask = 0;
8979
 
8980
                  if (bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec) < old_source_offset)
8981
                    {
8982
                      (*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
8983
                        (link_info, _("invalid relocation address"),
8984
                         abfd, sec, old_source_offset);
8985
                      goto error_return;
8986
                    }
8987
 
8988
                  switch (r_type)
8989
                    {
8990
                    case R_XTENSA_DIFF8:
8991
                      diff_value =
8992
                        bfd_get_8 (abfd, &contents[old_source_offset]);
8993
                      break;
8994
                    case R_XTENSA_DIFF16:
8995
                      diff_value =
8996
                        bfd_get_16 (abfd, &contents[old_source_offset]);
8997
                      break;
8998
                    case R_XTENSA_DIFF32:
8999
                      diff_value =
9000
                        bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[old_source_offset]);
9001
                      break;
9002
                    }
9003
 
9004
                  new_end_offset = offset_with_removed_text
9005
                    (&target_relax_info->action_list,
9006
                     r_rel.target_offset + diff_value);
9007
                  diff_value = new_end_offset - new_reloc.target_offset;
9008
 
9009
                  switch (r_type)
9010
                    {
9011
                    case R_XTENSA_DIFF8:
9012
                      diff_mask = 0xff;
9013
                      bfd_put_8 (abfd, diff_value,
9014
                                 &contents[old_source_offset]);
9015
                      break;
9016
                    case R_XTENSA_DIFF16:
9017
                      diff_mask = 0xffff;
9018
                      bfd_put_16 (abfd, diff_value,
9019
                                  &contents[old_source_offset]);
9020
                      break;
9021
                    case R_XTENSA_DIFF32:
9022
                      diff_mask = 0xffffffff;
9023
                      bfd_put_32 (abfd, diff_value,
9024
                                  &contents[old_source_offset]);
9025
                      break;
9026
                    }
9027
 
9028
                  /* Check for overflow.  */
9029
                  if ((diff_value & ~diff_mask) != 0)
9030
                    {
9031
                      (*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
9032
                        (link_info, _("overflow after relaxation"),
9033
                         abfd, sec, old_source_offset);
9034
                      goto error_return;
9035
                    }
9036
 
9037
                  pin_contents (sec, contents);
9038
                }
9039
 
9040
              /* If the relocation still references a section in the same
9041
                 input file, modify the relocation directly instead of
9042
                 adding a "fix" record.  */
9043
              if (target_sec->owner == abfd)
9044
                {
9045
                  unsigned r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (new_reloc.rela.r_info);
9046
                  irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
9047
                  irel->r_addend = new_reloc.rela.r_addend;
9048
                  pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
9049
                }
9050
              else
9051
                {
9052
                  bfd_vma addend_displacement;
9053
                  reloc_bfd_fix *fix;
9054
 
9055
                  addend_displacement =
9056
                    new_reloc.target_offset + new_reloc.virtual_offset;
9057
                  fix = reloc_bfd_fix_init (sec, source_offset, r_type,
9058
                                            target_sec,
9059
                                            addend_displacement, TRUE);
9060
                  add_fix (sec, fix);
9061
                }
9062
            }
9063
        }
9064
    }
9065
 
9066
  if ((relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
9067
       || relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
9068
      && relax_info->action_list.head)
9069
    {
9070
      /* Walk through the planned actions and build up a table
9071
         of move, copy and fill records.  Use the move, copy and
9072
         fill records to perform the actions once.  */
9073
 
9074
      int removed = 0;
9075
      bfd_size_type final_size, copy_size, orig_insn_size;
9076
      bfd_byte *scratch = NULL;
9077
      bfd_byte *dup_contents = NULL;
9078
      bfd_size_type orig_size = sec->size;
9079
      bfd_vma orig_dot = 0;
9080
      bfd_vma orig_dot_copied = 0; /* Byte copied already from
9081
                                            orig dot in physical memory.  */
9082
      bfd_vma orig_dot_vo = 0; /* Virtual offset from orig_dot.  */
9083
      bfd_vma dup_dot = 0;
9084
 
9085
      text_action *action = relax_info->action_list.head;
9086
 
9087
      final_size = sec->size;
9088
      for (action = relax_info->action_list.head; action;
9089
           action = action->next)
9090
        {
9091
          final_size -= action->removed_bytes;
9092
        }
9093
 
9094
      scratch = (bfd_byte *) bfd_zmalloc (final_size);
9095
      dup_contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_zmalloc (final_size);
9096
 
9097
      /* The dot is the current fill location.  */
9098
#if DEBUG
9099
      print_action_list (stderr, &relax_info->action_list);
9100
#endif
9101
 
9102
      for (action = relax_info->action_list.head; action;
9103
           action = action->next)
9104
        {
9105
          virtual_action = FALSE;
9106
          if (action->offset > orig_dot)
9107
            {
9108
              orig_dot += orig_dot_copied;
9109
              orig_dot_copied = 0;
9110
              orig_dot_vo = 0;
9111
              /* Out of the virtual world.  */
9112
            }
9113
 
9114
          if (action->offset > orig_dot)
9115
            {
9116
              copy_size = action->offset - orig_dot;
9117
              memmove (&dup_contents[dup_dot], &contents[orig_dot], copy_size);
9118
              orig_dot += copy_size;
9119
              dup_dot += copy_size;
9120
              BFD_ASSERT (action->offset == orig_dot);
9121
            }
9122
          else if (action->offset < orig_dot)
9123
            {
9124
              if (action->action == ta_fill
9125
                  && action->offset - action->removed_bytes == orig_dot)
9126
                {
9127
                  /* This is OK because the fill only effects the dup_dot.  */
9128
                }
9129
              else if (action->action == ta_add_literal)
9130
                {
9131
                  /* TBD.  Might need to handle this.  */
9132
                }
9133
            }
9134
          if (action->offset == orig_dot)
9135
            {
9136
              if (action->virtual_offset > orig_dot_vo)
9137
                {
9138
                  if (orig_dot_vo == 0)
9139
                    {
9140
                      /* Need to copy virtual_offset bytes.  Probably four.  */
9141
                      copy_size = action->virtual_offset - orig_dot_vo;
9142
                      memmove (&dup_contents[dup_dot],
9143
                               &contents[orig_dot], copy_size);
9144
                      orig_dot_copied = copy_size;
9145
                      dup_dot += copy_size;
9146
                    }
9147
                  virtual_action = TRUE;
9148
                }
9149
              else
9150
                BFD_ASSERT (action->virtual_offset <= orig_dot_vo);
9151
            }
9152
          switch (action->action)
9153
            {
9154
            case ta_remove_literal:
9155
            case ta_remove_insn:
9156
              BFD_ASSERT (action->removed_bytes >= 0);
9157
              orig_dot += action->removed_bytes;
9158
              break;
9159
 
9160
            case ta_narrow_insn:
9161
              orig_insn_size = 3;
9162
              copy_size = 2;
9163
              memmove (scratch, &contents[orig_dot], orig_insn_size);
9164
              BFD_ASSERT (action->removed_bytes == 1);
9165
              rv = narrow_instruction (scratch, final_size, 0);
9166
              BFD_ASSERT (rv);
9167
              memmove (&dup_contents[dup_dot], scratch, copy_size);
9168
              orig_dot += orig_insn_size;
9169
              dup_dot += copy_size;
9170
              break;
9171
 
9172
            case ta_fill:
9173
              if (action->removed_bytes >= 0)
9174
                orig_dot += action->removed_bytes;
9175
              else
9176
                {
9177
                  /* Already zeroed in dup_contents.  Just bump the
9178
                     counters.  */
9179
                  dup_dot += (-action->removed_bytes);
9180
                }
9181
              break;
9182
 
9183
            case ta_none:
9184
              BFD_ASSERT (action->removed_bytes == 0);
9185
              break;
9186
 
9187
            case ta_convert_longcall:
9188
            case ta_remove_longcall:
9189
              /* These will be removed or converted before we get here.  */
9190
              BFD_ASSERT (0);
9191
              break;
9192
 
9193
            case ta_widen_insn:
9194
              orig_insn_size = 2;
9195
              copy_size = 3;
9196
              memmove (scratch, &contents[orig_dot], orig_insn_size);
9197
              BFD_ASSERT (action->removed_bytes == -1);
9198
              rv = widen_instruction (scratch, final_size, 0);
9199
              BFD_ASSERT (rv);
9200
              memmove (&dup_contents[dup_dot], scratch, copy_size);
9201
              orig_dot += orig_insn_size;
9202
              dup_dot += copy_size;
9203
              break;
9204
 
9205
            case ta_add_literal:
9206
              orig_insn_size = 0;
9207
              copy_size = 4;
9208
              BFD_ASSERT (action->removed_bytes == -4);
9209
              /* TBD -- place the literal value here and insert
9210
                 into the table.  */
9211
              memset (&dup_contents[dup_dot], 0, 4);
9212
              pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
9213
              pin_contents (sec, contents);
9214
 
9215
              if (!move_literal (abfd, link_info, sec, dup_dot, dup_contents,
9216
                                 relax_info, &internal_relocs, &action->value))
9217
                goto error_return;
9218
 
9219
              if (virtual_action)
9220
                orig_dot_vo += copy_size;
9221
 
9222
              orig_dot += orig_insn_size;
9223
              dup_dot += copy_size;
9224
              break;
9225
 
9226
            default:
9227
              /* Not implemented yet.  */
9228
              BFD_ASSERT (0);
9229
              break;
9230
            }
9231
 
9232
          removed += action->removed_bytes;
9233
          BFD_ASSERT (dup_dot <= final_size);
9234
          BFD_ASSERT (orig_dot <= orig_size);
9235
        }
9236
 
9237
      orig_dot += orig_dot_copied;
9238
      orig_dot_copied = 0;
9239
 
9240
      if (orig_dot != orig_size)
9241
        {
9242
          copy_size = orig_size - orig_dot;
9243
          BFD_ASSERT (orig_size > orig_dot);
9244
          BFD_ASSERT (dup_dot + copy_size == final_size);
9245
          memmove (&dup_contents[dup_dot], &contents[orig_dot], copy_size);
9246
          orig_dot += copy_size;
9247
          dup_dot += copy_size;
9248
        }
9249
      BFD_ASSERT (orig_size == orig_dot);
9250
      BFD_ASSERT (final_size == dup_dot);
9251
 
9252
      /* Move the dup_contents back.  */
9253
      if (final_size > orig_size)
9254
        {
9255
          /* Contents need to be reallocated.  Swap the dup_contents into
9256
             contents.  */
9257
          sec->contents = dup_contents;
9258
          free (contents);
9259
          contents = dup_contents;
9260
          pin_contents (sec, contents);
9261
        }
9262
      else
9263
        {
9264
          BFD_ASSERT (final_size <= orig_size);
9265
          memset (contents, 0, orig_size);
9266
          memcpy (contents, dup_contents, final_size);
9267
          free (dup_contents);
9268
        }
9269
      free (scratch);
9270
      pin_contents (sec, contents);
9271
 
9272
      if (sec->rawsize == 0)
9273
        sec->rawsize = sec->size;
9274
      sec->size = final_size;
9275
    }
9276
 
9277
 error_return:
9278
  release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
9279
  release_contents (sec, contents);
9280
  return ok;
9281
}
9282
 
9283
 
9284
static bfd_boolean
9285
translate_section_fixes (asection *sec)
9286
{
9287
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
9288
  reloc_bfd_fix *r;
9289
 
9290
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
9291
  if (!relax_info)
9292
    return TRUE;
9293
 
9294
  for (r = relax_info->fix_list; r != NULL; r = r->next)
9295
    if (!translate_reloc_bfd_fix (r))
9296
      return FALSE;
9297
 
9298
  return TRUE;
9299
}
9300
 
9301
 
9302
/* Translate a fix given the mapping in the relax info for the target
9303
   section.  If it has already been translated, no work is required.  */
9304
 
9305
static bfd_boolean
9306
translate_reloc_bfd_fix (reloc_bfd_fix *fix)
9307
{
9308
  reloc_bfd_fix new_fix;
9309
  asection *sec;
9310
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
9311
  removed_literal *removed;
9312
  bfd_vma new_offset, target_offset;
9313
 
9314
  if (fix->translated)
9315
    return TRUE;
9316
 
9317
  sec = fix->target_sec;
9318
  target_offset = fix->target_offset;
9319
 
9320
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
9321
  if (!relax_info)
9322
    {
9323
      fix->translated = TRUE;
9324
      return TRUE;
9325
    }
9326
 
9327
  new_fix = *fix;
9328
 
9329
  /* The fix does not need to be translated if the section cannot change.  */
9330
  if (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
9331
      && !relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
9332
    {
9333
      fix->translated = TRUE;
9334
      return TRUE;
9335
    }
9336
 
9337
  /* If the literal has been moved and this relocation was on an
9338
     opcode, then the relocation should move to the new literal
9339
     location.  Otherwise, the relocation should move within the
9340
     section.  */
9341
 
9342
  removed = FALSE;
9343
  if (is_operand_relocation (fix->src_type))
9344
    {
9345
      /* Check if the original relocation is against a literal being
9346
         removed.  */
9347
      removed = find_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list,
9348
                                      target_offset);
9349
    }
9350
 
9351
  if (removed)
9352
    {
9353
      asection *new_sec;
9354
 
9355
      /* The fact that there is still a relocation to this literal indicates
9356
         that the literal is being coalesced, not simply removed.  */
9357
      BFD_ASSERT (removed->to.abfd != NULL);
9358
 
9359
      /* This was moved to some other address (possibly another section).  */
9360
      new_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&removed->to);
9361
      if (new_sec != sec)
9362
        {
9363
          sec = new_sec;
9364
          relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
9365
          if (!relax_info ||
9366
              (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
9367
               && !relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section))
9368
            {
9369
              target_offset = removed->to.target_offset;
9370
              new_fix.target_sec = new_sec;
9371
              new_fix.target_offset = target_offset;
9372
              new_fix.translated = TRUE;
9373
              *fix = new_fix;
9374
              return TRUE;
9375
            }
9376
        }
9377
      target_offset = removed->to.target_offset;
9378
      new_fix.target_sec = new_sec;
9379
    }
9380
 
9381
  /* The target address may have been moved within its section.  */
9382
  new_offset = offset_with_removed_text (&relax_info->action_list,
9383
                                         target_offset);
9384
 
9385
  new_fix.target_offset = new_offset;
9386
  new_fix.target_offset = new_offset;
9387
  new_fix.translated = TRUE;
9388
  *fix = new_fix;
9389
  return TRUE;
9390
}
9391
 
9392
 
9393
/* Fix up a relocation to take account of removed literals.  */
9394
 
9395
static asection *
9396
translate_reloc (const r_reloc *orig_rel, r_reloc *new_rel, asection *sec)
9397
{
9398
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
9399
  removed_literal *removed;
9400
  bfd_vma target_offset, base_offset;
9401
  text_action *act;
9402
 
9403
  *new_rel = *orig_rel;
9404
 
9405
  if (!r_reloc_is_defined (orig_rel))
9406
    return sec ;
9407
 
9408
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
9409
  BFD_ASSERT (relax_info && (relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
9410
                             || relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section));
9411
 
9412
  target_offset = orig_rel->target_offset;
9413
 
9414
  removed = FALSE;
9415
  if (is_operand_relocation (ELF32_R_TYPE (orig_rel->rela.r_info)))
9416
    {
9417
      /* Check if the original relocation is against a literal being
9418
         removed.  */
9419
      removed = find_removed_literal (&relax_info->removed_list,
9420
                                      target_offset);
9421
    }
9422
  if (removed && removed->to.abfd)
9423
    {
9424
      asection *new_sec;
9425
 
9426
      /* The fact that there is still a relocation to this literal indicates
9427
         that the literal is being coalesced, not simply removed.  */
9428
      BFD_ASSERT (removed->to.abfd != NULL);
9429
 
9430
      /* This was moved to some other address
9431
         (possibly in another section).  */
9432
      *new_rel = removed->to;
9433
      new_sec = r_reloc_get_section (new_rel);
9434
      if (new_sec != sec)
9435
        {
9436
          sec = new_sec;
9437
          relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
9438
          if (!relax_info
9439
              || (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
9440
                  && !relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section))
9441
            return sec;
9442
        }
9443
      target_offset = new_rel->target_offset;
9444
    }
9445
 
9446
  /* Find the base offset of the reloc symbol, excluding any addend from the
9447
     reloc or from the section contents (for a partial_inplace reloc).  Then
9448
     find the adjusted values of the offsets due to relaxation.  The base
9449
     offset is needed to determine the change to the reloc's addend; the reloc
9450
     addend should not be adjusted due to relaxations located before the base
9451
     offset.  */
9452
 
9453
  base_offset = r_reloc_get_target_offset (new_rel) - new_rel->rela.r_addend;
9454
  act = relax_info->action_list.head;
9455
  if (base_offset <= target_offset)
9456
    {
9457
      int base_removed = removed_by_actions (&act, base_offset, FALSE);
9458
      int addend_removed = removed_by_actions (&act, target_offset, FALSE);
9459
      new_rel->target_offset = target_offset - base_removed - addend_removed;
9460
      new_rel->rela.r_addend -= addend_removed;
9461
    }
9462
  else
9463
    {
9464
      /* Handle a negative addend.  The base offset comes first.  */
9465
      int tgt_removed = removed_by_actions (&act, target_offset, FALSE);
9466
      int addend_removed = removed_by_actions (&act, base_offset, FALSE);
9467
      new_rel->target_offset = target_offset - tgt_removed;
9468
      new_rel->rela.r_addend += addend_removed;
9469
    }
9470
 
9471
  return sec;
9472
}
9473
 
9474
 
9475
/* For dynamic links, there may be a dynamic relocation for each
9476
   literal.  The number of dynamic relocations must be computed in
9477
   size_dynamic_sections, which occurs before relaxation.  When a
9478
   literal is removed, this function checks if there is a corresponding
9479
   dynamic relocation and shrinks the size of the appropriate dynamic
9480
   relocation section accordingly.  At this point, the contents of the
9481
   dynamic relocation sections have not yet been filled in, so there's
9482
   nothing else that needs to be done.  */
9483
 
9484
static void
9485
shrink_dynamic_reloc_sections (struct bfd_link_info *info,
9486
                               bfd *abfd,
9487
                               asection *input_section,
9488
                               Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
9489
{
9490
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
9491
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9492
  struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
9493
  unsigned long r_symndx;
9494
  int r_type;
9495
  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9496
  bfd_boolean dynamic_symbol;
9497
 
9498
  htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
9499
  symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
9500
  sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
9501
 
9502
  r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
9503
  r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
9504
 
9505
  if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
9506
    h = NULL;
9507
  else
9508
    h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
9509
 
9510
  dynamic_symbol = elf_xtensa_dynamic_symbol_p (h, info);
9511
 
9512
  if ((r_type == R_XTENSA_32 || r_type == R_XTENSA_PLT)
9513
      && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
9514
      && (dynamic_symbol || info->shared))
9515
    {
9516
      asection *srel;
9517
      bfd_boolean is_plt = FALSE;
9518
 
9519
      if (dynamic_symbol && r_type == R_XTENSA_PLT)
9520
        {
9521
          srel = htab->srelplt;
9522
          is_plt = TRUE;
9523
        }
9524
      else
9525
        srel = htab->srelgot;
9526
 
9527
      /* Reduce size of the .rela.* section by one reloc.  */
9528
      BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
9529
      BFD_ASSERT (srel->size >= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9530
      srel->size -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9531
 
9532
      if (is_plt)
9533
        {
9534
          asection *splt, *sgotplt, *srelgot;
9535
          int reloc_index, chunk;
9536
 
9537
          /* Find the PLT reloc index of the entry being removed.  This
9538
             is computed from the size of ".rela.plt".  It is needed to
9539
             figure out which PLT chunk to resize.  Usually "last index
9540
             = size - 1" since the index starts at zero, but in this
9541
             context, the size has just been decremented so there's no
9542
             need to subtract one.  */
9543
          reloc_index = srel->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9544
 
9545
          chunk = reloc_index / PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK;
9546
          splt = elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (info, chunk);
9547
          sgotplt = elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (info, chunk);
9548
          BFD_ASSERT (splt != NULL && sgotplt != NULL);
9549
 
9550
          /* Check if an entire PLT chunk has just been eliminated.  */
9551
          if (reloc_index % PLT_ENTRIES_PER_CHUNK == 0)
9552
            {
9553
              /* The two magic GOT entries for that chunk can go away.  */
9554
              srelgot = htab->srelgot;
9555
              BFD_ASSERT (srelgot != NULL);
9556
              srelgot->reloc_count -= 2;
9557
              srelgot->size -= 2 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9558
              sgotplt->size -= 8;
9559
 
9560
              /* There should be only one entry left (and it will be
9561
                 removed below).  */
9562
              BFD_ASSERT (sgotplt->size == 4);
9563
              BFD_ASSERT (splt->size == PLT_ENTRY_SIZE);
9564
            }
9565
 
9566
          BFD_ASSERT (sgotplt->size >= 4);
9567
          BFD_ASSERT (splt->size >= PLT_ENTRY_SIZE);
9568
 
9569
          sgotplt->size -= 4;
9570
          splt->size -= PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
9571
        }
9572
    }
9573
}
9574
 
9575
 
9576
/* Take an r_rel and move it to another section.  This usually
9577
   requires extending the interal_relocation array and pinning it.  If
9578
   the original r_rel is from the same BFD, we can complete this here.
9579
   Otherwise, we add a fix record to let the final link fix the
9580
   appropriate address.  Contents and internal relocations for the
9581
   section must be pinned after calling this routine.  */
9582
 
9583
static bfd_boolean
9584
move_literal (bfd *abfd,
9585
              struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
9586
              asection *sec,
9587
              bfd_vma offset,
9588
              bfd_byte *contents,
9589
              xtensa_relax_info *relax_info,
9590
              Elf_Internal_Rela **internal_relocs_p,
9591
              const literal_value *lit)
9592
{
9593
  Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = NULL;
9594
  size_t new_relocs_count = 0;
9595
  Elf_Internal_Rela this_rela;
9596
  const r_reloc *r_rel;
9597
 
9598
  r_rel = &lit->r_rel;
9599
  BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs == *internal_relocs_p);
9600
 
9601
  if (r_reloc_is_const (r_rel))
9602
    bfd_put_32 (abfd, lit->value, contents + offset);
9603
  else
9604
    {
9605
      int r_type;
9606
      unsigned i;
9607
      asection *target_sec;
9608
      reloc_bfd_fix *fix;
9609
      unsigned insert_at;
9610
 
9611
      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (r_rel->rela.r_info);
9612
      target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (r_rel);
9613
 
9614
      /* This is the difficult case.  We have to create a fix up.  */
9615
      this_rela.r_offset = offset;
9616
      this_rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
9617
      this_rela.r_addend =
9618
        r_rel->target_offset - r_reloc_get_target_offset (r_rel);
9619
      bfd_put_32 (abfd, lit->value, contents + offset);
9620
 
9621
      /* Currently, we cannot move relocations during a relocatable link.  */
9622
      BFD_ASSERT (!link_info->relocatable);
9623
      fix = reloc_bfd_fix_init (sec, offset, r_type,
9624
                                r_reloc_get_section (r_rel),
9625
                                r_rel->target_offset + r_rel->virtual_offset,
9626
                                FALSE);
9627
      /* We also need to mark that relocations are needed here.  */
9628
      sec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
9629
 
9630
      translate_reloc_bfd_fix (fix);
9631
      /* This fix has not yet been translated.  */
9632
      add_fix (sec, fix);
9633
 
9634
      /* Add the relocation.  If we have already allocated our own
9635
         space for the relocations and we have room for more, then use
9636
         it.  Otherwise, allocate new space and move the literals.  */
9637
      insert_at = sec->reloc_count;
9638
      for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; ++i)
9639
        {
9640
          if (this_rela.r_offset < (*internal_relocs_p)[i].r_offset)
9641
            {
9642
              insert_at = i;
9643
              break;
9644
            }
9645
        }
9646
 
9647
      if (*internal_relocs_p != relax_info->allocated_relocs
9648
          || sec->reloc_count + 1 > relax_info->allocated_relocs_count)
9649
        {
9650
          BFD_ASSERT (relax_info->allocated_relocs == NULL
9651
                      || sec->reloc_count == relax_info->relocs_count);
9652
 
9653
          if (relax_info->allocated_relocs_count == 0)
9654
            new_relocs_count = (sec->reloc_count + 2) * 2;
9655
          else
9656
            new_relocs_count = (relax_info->allocated_relocs_count + 2) * 2;
9657
 
9658
          new_relocs = (Elf_Internal_Rela *)
9659
            bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela) * (new_relocs_count));
9660
          if (!new_relocs)
9661
            return FALSE;
9662
 
9663
          /* We could handle this more quickly by finding the split point.  */
9664
          if (insert_at != 0)
9665
            memcpy (new_relocs, *internal_relocs_p,
9666
                    insert_at * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela));
9667
 
9668
          new_relocs[insert_at] = this_rela;
9669
 
9670
          if (insert_at != sec->reloc_count)
9671
            memcpy (new_relocs + insert_at + 1,
9672
                    (*internal_relocs_p) + insert_at,
9673
                    (sec->reloc_count - insert_at)
9674
                    * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela));
9675
 
9676
          if (*internal_relocs_p != relax_info->allocated_relocs)
9677
            {
9678
              /* The first time we re-allocate, we can only free the
9679
                 old relocs if they were allocated with bfd_malloc.
9680
                 This is not true when keep_memory is in effect.  */
9681
              if (!link_info->keep_memory)
9682
                free (*internal_relocs_p);
9683
            }
9684
          else
9685
            free (*internal_relocs_p);
9686
          relax_info->allocated_relocs = new_relocs;
9687
          relax_info->allocated_relocs_count = new_relocs_count;
9688
          elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = new_relocs;
9689
          sec->reloc_count++;
9690
          relax_info->relocs_count = sec->reloc_count;
9691
          *internal_relocs_p = new_relocs;
9692
        }
9693
      else
9694
        {
9695
          if (insert_at != sec->reloc_count)
9696
            {
9697
              unsigned idx;
9698
              for (idx = sec->reloc_count; idx > insert_at; idx--)
9699
                (*internal_relocs_p)[idx] = (*internal_relocs_p)[idx-1];
9700
            }
9701
          (*internal_relocs_p)[insert_at] = this_rela;
9702
          sec->reloc_count++;
9703
          if (relax_info->allocated_relocs)
9704
            relax_info->relocs_count = sec->reloc_count;
9705
        }
9706
    }
9707
  return TRUE;
9708
}
9709
 
9710
 
9711
/* This is similar to relax_section except that when a target is moved,
9712
   we shift addresses up.  We also need to modify the size.  This
9713
   algorithm does NOT allow for relocations into the middle of the
9714
   property sections.  */
9715
 
9716
static bfd_boolean
9717
relax_property_section (bfd *abfd,
9718
                        asection *sec,
9719
                        struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
9720
{
9721
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
9722
  bfd_byte *contents;
9723
  unsigned i;
9724
  bfd_boolean ok = TRUE;
9725
  bfd_boolean is_full_prop_section;
9726
  size_t last_zfill_target_offset = 0;
9727
  asection *last_zfill_target_sec = NULL;
9728
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
9729
  bfd_size_type entry_size;
9730
 
9731
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
9732
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
9733
                                              link_info->keep_memory);
9734
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
9735
  if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
9736
    {
9737
      ok = FALSE;
9738
      goto error_return;
9739
    }
9740
 
9741
  is_full_prop_section = xtensa_is_proptable_section (sec);
9742
  if (is_full_prop_section)
9743
    entry_size = 12;
9744
  else
9745
    entry_size = 8;
9746
 
9747
  if (internal_relocs)
9748
    {
9749
      for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
9750
        {
9751
          Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
9752
          xtensa_relax_info *target_relax_info;
9753
          unsigned r_type;
9754
          asection *target_sec;
9755
          literal_value val;
9756
          bfd_byte *size_p, *flags_p;
9757
 
9758
          /* Locally change the source address.
9759
             Translate the target to the new target address.
9760
             If it points to this section and has been removed, MOVE IT.
9761
             Also, don't forget to modify the associated SIZE at
9762
             (offset + 4).  */
9763
 
9764
          irel = &internal_relocs[i];
9765
          r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
9766
          if (r_type == R_XTENSA_NONE)
9767
            continue;
9768
 
9769
          /* Find the literal value.  */
9770
          r_reloc_init (&val.r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
9771
          size_p = &contents[irel->r_offset + 4];
9772
          flags_p = NULL;
9773
          if (is_full_prop_section)
9774
            flags_p = &contents[irel->r_offset + 8];
9775
          BFD_ASSERT (irel->r_offset + entry_size <= sec_size);
9776
 
9777
          target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&val.r_rel);
9778
          target_relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (target_sec);
9779
 
9780
          if (target_relax_info
9781
              && (target_relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
9782
                  || target_relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section ))
9783
            {
9784
              /* Translate the relocation's destination.  */
9785
              bfd_vma old_offset = val.r_rel.target_offset;
9786
              bfd_vma new_offset;
9787
              long old_size, new_size;
9788
              text_action *act = target_relax_info->action_list.head;
9789
              new_offset = old_offset -
9790
                removed_by_actions (&act, old_offset, FALSE);
9791
 
9792
              /* Assert that we are not out of bounds.  */
9793
              old_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, size_p);
9794
              new_size = old_size;
9795
 
9796
              if (old_size == 0)
9797
                {
9798
                  /* Only the first zero-sized unreachable entry is
9799
                     allowed to expand.  In this case the new offset
9800
                     should be the offset before the fill and the new
9801
                     size is the expansion size.  For other zero-sized
9802
                     entries the resulting size should be zero with an
9803
                     offset before or after the fill address depending
9804
                     on whether the expanding unreachable entry
9805
                     preceeds it.  */
9806
                  if (last_zfill_target_sec == 0
9807
                      || last_zfill_target_sec != target_sec
9808
                      || last_zfill_target_offset != old_offset)
9809
                    {
9810
                      bfd_vma new_end_offset = new_offset;
9811
 
9812
                      /* Recompute the new_offset, but this time don't
9813
                         include any fill inserted by relaxation.  */
9814
                      act = target_relax_info->action_list.head;
9815
                      new_offset = old_offset -
9816
                        removed_by_actions (&act, old_offset, TRUE);
9817
 
9818
                      /* If it is not unreachable and we have not yet
9819
                         seen an unreachable at this address, place it
9820
                         before the fill address.  */
9821
                      if (flags_p && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, flags_p)
9822
                                      & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE) != 0)
9823
                        {
9824
                          new_size = new_end_offset - new_offset;
9825
 
9826
                          last_zfill_target_sec = target_sec;
9827
                          last_zfill_target_offset = old_offset;
9828
                        }
9829
                    }
9830
                }
9831
              else
9832
                new_size -=
9833
                    removed_by_actions (&act, old_offset + old_size, TRUE);
9834
 
9835
              if (new_size != old_size)
9836
                {
9837
                  bfd_put_32 (abfd, new_size, size_p);
9838
                  pin_contents (sec, contents);
9839
                }
9840
 
9841
              if (new_offset != old_offset)
9842
                {
9843
                  bfd_vma diff = new_offset - old_offset;
9844
                  irel->r_addend += diff;
9845
                  pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
9846
                }
9847
            }
9848
        }
9849
    }
9850
 
9851
  /* Combine adjacent property table entries.  This is also done in
9852
     finish_dynamic_sections() but at that point it's too late to
9853
     reclaim the space in the output section, so we do this twice.  */
9854
 
9855
  if (internal_relocs && (!link_info->relocatable
9856
                          || xtensa_is_littable_section (sec)))
9857
    {
9858
      Elf_Internal_Rela *last_irel = NULL;
9859
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *next_rel, *rel_end;
9860
      int removed_bytes = 0;
9861
      bfd_vma offset;
9862
      flagword predef_flags;
9863
 
9864
      predef_flags = xtensa_get_property_predef_flags (sec);
9865
 
9866
      /* Walk over memory and relocations at the same time.
9867
         This REQUIRES that the internal_relocs be sorted by offset.  */
9868
      qsort (internal_relocs, sec->reloc_count, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Rela),
9869
             internal_reloc_compare);
9870
 
9871
      pin_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
9872
      pin_contents (sec, contents);
9873
 
9874
      next_rel = internal_relocs;
9875
      rel_end = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count;
9876
 
9877
      BFD_ASSERT (sec->size % entry_size == 0);
9878
 
9879
      for (offset = 0; offset < sec->size; offset += entry_size)
9880
        {
9881
          Elf_Internal_Rela *offset_rel, *extra_rel;
9882
          bfd_vma bytes_to_remove, size, actual_offset;
9883
          bfd_boolean remove_this_rel;
9884
          flagword flags;
9885
 
9886
          /* Find the first relocation for the entry at the current offset.
9887
             Adjust the offsets of any extra relocations for the previous
9888
             entry.  */
9889
          offset_rel = NULL;
9890
          if (next_rel)
9891
            {
9892
              for (irel = next_rel; irel < rel_end; irel++)
9893
                {
9894
                  if ((irel->r_offset == offset
9895
                       && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_NONE)
9896
                      || irel->r_offset > offset)
9897
                    {
9898
                      offset_rel = irel;
9899
                      break;
9900
                    }
9901
                  irel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
9902
                }
9903
            }
9904
 
9905
          /* Find the next relocation (if there are any left).  */
9906
          extra_rel = NULL;
9907
          if (offset_rel)
9908
            {
9909
              for (irel = offset_rel + 1; irel < rel_end; irel++)
9910
                {
9911
                  if (ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) != R_XTENSA_NONE)
9912
                    {
9913
                      extra_rel = irel;
9914
                      break;
9915
                    }
9916
                }
9917
            }
9918
 
9919
          /* Check if there are relocations on the current entry.  There
9920
             should usually be a relocation on the offset field.  If there
9921
             are relocations on the size or flags, then we can't optimize
9922
             this entry.  Also, find the next relocation to examine on the
9923
             next iteration.  */
9924
          if (offset_rel)
9925
            {
9926
              if (offset_rel->r_offset >= offset + entry_size)
9927
                {
9928
                  next_rel = offset_rel;
9929
                  /* There are no relocations on the current entry, but we
9930
                     might still be able to remove it if the size is zero.  */
9931
                  offset_rel = NULL;
9932
                }
9933
              else if (offset_rel->r_offset > offset
9934
                       || (extra_rel
9935
                           && extra_rel->r_offset < offset + entry_size))
9936
                {
9937
                  /* There is a relocation on the size or flags, so we can't
9938
                     do anything with this entry.  Continue with the next.  */
9939
                  next_rel = offset_rel;
9940
                  continue;
9941
                }
9942
              else
9943
                {
9944
                  BFD_ASSERT (offset_rel->r_offset == offset);
9945
                  offset_rel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
9946
                  next_rel = offset_rel + 1;
9947
                }
9948
            }
9949
          else
9950
            next_rel = NULL;
9951
 
9952
          remove_this_rel = FALSE;
9953
          bytes_to_remove = 0;
9954
          actual_offset = offset - removed_bytes;
9955
          size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[actual_offset + 4]);
9956
 
9957
          if (is_full_prop_section)
9958
            flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[actual_offset + 8]);
9959
          else
9960
            flags = predef_flags;
9961
 
9962
          if (size == 0
9963
              && (flags & XTENSA_PROP_ALIGN) == 0
9964
              && (flags & XTENSA_PROP_UNREACHABLE) == 0)
9965
            {
9966
              /* Always remove entries with zero size and no alignment.  */
9967
              bytes_to_remove = entry_size;
9968
              if (offset_rel)
9969
                remove_this_rel = TRUE;
9970
            }
9971
          else if (offset_rel
9972
                   && ELF32_R_TYPE (offset_rel->r_info) == R_XTENSA_32)
9973
            {
9974
              if (last_irel)
9975
                {
9976
                  flagword old_flags;
9977
                  bfd_vma old_size =
9978
                    bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[last_irel->r_offset + 4]);
9979
                  bfd_vma old_address =
9980
                    (last_irel->r_addend
9981
                     + bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[last_irel->r_offset]));
9982
                  bfd_vma new_address =
9983
                    (offset_rel->r_addend
9984
                     + bfd_get_32 (abfd, &contents[actual_offset]));
9985
                  if (is_full_prop_section)
9986
                    old_flags = bfd_get_32
9987
                      (abfd, &contents[last_irel->r_offset + 8]);
9988
                  else
9989
                    old_flags = predef_flags;
9990
 
9991
                  if ((ELF32_R_SYM (offset_rel->r_info)
9992
                       == ELF32_R_SYM (last_irel->r_info))
9993
                      && old_address + old_size == new_address
9994
                      && old_flags == flags
9995
                      && (old_flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN_BRANCH_TARGET) == 0
9996
                      && (old_flags & XTENSA_PROP_INSN_LOOP_TARGET) == 0)
9997
                    {
9998
                      /* Fix the old size.  */
9999
                      bfd_put_32 (abfd, old_size + size,
10000
                                  &contents[last_irel->r_offset + 4]);
10001
                      bytes_to_remove = entry_size;
10002
                      remove_this_rel = TRUE;
10003
                    }
10004
                  else
10005
                    last_irel = offset_rel;
10006
                }
10007
              else
10008
                last_irel = offset_rel;
10009
            }
10010
 
10011
          if (remove_this_rel)
10012
            {
10013
              offset_rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_XTENSA_NONE);
10014
              offset_rel->r_offset = 0;
10015
            }
10016
 
10017
          if (bytes_to_remove != 0)
10018
            {
10019
              removed_bytes += bytes_to_remove;
10020
              if (offset + bytes_to_remove < sec->size)
10021
                memmove (&contents[actual_offset],
10022
                         &contents[actual_offset + bytes_to_remove],
10023
                         sec->size - offset - bytes_to_remove);
10024
            }
10025
        }
10026
 
10027
      if (removed_bytes)
10028
        {
10029
          /* Fix up any extra relocations on the last entry.  */
10030
          for (irel = next_rel; irel < rel_end; irel++)
10031
            irel->r_offset -= removed_bytes;
10032
 
10033
          /* Clear the removed bytes.  */
10034
          memset (&contents[sec->size - removed_bytes], 0, removed_bytes);
10035
 
10036
          if (sec->rawsize == 0)
10037
            sec->rawsize = sec->size;
10038
          sec->size -= removed_bytes;
10039
 
10040
          if (xtensa_is_littable_section (sec))
10041
            {
10042
              asection *sgotloc = elf_xtensa_hash_table (link_info)->sgotloc;
10043
              if (sgotloc)
10044
                sgotloc->size -= removed_bytes;
10045
            }
10046
        }
10047
    }
10048
 
10049
 error_return:
10050
  release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
10051
  release_contents (sec, contents);
10052
  return ok;
10053
}
10054
 
10055
 
10056
/* Third relaxation pass.  */
10057
 
10058
/* Change symbol values to account for removed literals.  */
10059
 
10060
bfd_boolean
10061
relax_section_symbols (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10062
{
10063
  xtensa_relax_info *relax_info;
10064
  unsigned int sec_shndx;
10065
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
10066
  Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf;
10067
  unsigned i, num_syms, num_locals;
10068
 
10069
  relax_info = get_xtensa_relax_info (sec);
10070
  BFD_ASSERT (relax_info);
10071
 
10072
  if (!relax_info->is_relaxable_literal_section
10073
      && !relax_info->is_relaxable_asm_section)
10074
    return TRUE;
10075
 
10076
  sec_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
10077
 
10078
  symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
10079
  isymbuf = retrieve_local_syms (abfd);
10080
 
10081
  num_syms = symtab_hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Sym);
10082
  num_locals = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
10083
 
10084
  /* Adjust the local symbols defined in this section.  */
10085
  for (i = 0; i < num_locals; i++)
10086
    {
10087
      Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = &isymbuf[i];
10088
 
10089
      if (isym->st_shndx == sec_shndx)
10090
        {
10091
          text_action *act = relax_info->action_list.head;
10092
          bfd_vma orig_addr = isym->st_value;
10093
 
10094
          isym->st_value -= removed_by_actions (&act, orig_addr, FALSE);
10095
 
10096
          if (ELF32_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_FUNC)
10097
            isym->st_size -=
10098
              removed_by_actions (&act, orig_addr + isym->st_size, FALSE);
10099
        }
10100
    }
10101
 
10102
  /* Now adjust the global symbols defined in this section.  */
10103
  for (i = 0; i < (num_syms - num_locals); i++)
10104
    {
10105
      struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym_hash;
10106
 
10107
      sym_hash = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[i];
10108
 
10109
      if (sym_hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
10110
        sym_hash = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) sym_hash->root.u.i.link;
10111
 
10112
      if ((sym_hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
10113
           || sym_hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
10114
          && sym_hash->root.u.def.section == sec)
10115
        {
10116
          text_action *act = relax_info->action_list.head;
10117
          bfd_vma orig_addr = sym_hash->root.u.def.value;
10118
 
10119
          sym_hash->root.u.def.value -=
10120
            removed_by_actions (&act, orig_addr, FALSE);
10121
 
10122
          if (sym_hash->type == STT_FUNC)
10123
            sym_hash->size -=
10124
              removed_by_actions (&act, orig_addr + sym_hash->size, FALSE);
10125
        }
10126
    }
10127
 
10128
  return TRUE;
10129
}
10130
 
10131
 
10132
/* "Fix" handling functions, called while performing relocations.  */
10133
 
10134
static bfd_boolean
10135
do_fix_for_relocatable_link (Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
10136
                             bfd *input_bfd,
10137
                             asection *input_section,
10138
                             bfd_byte *contents)
10139
{
10140
  r_reloc r_rel;
10141
  asection *sec, *old_sec;
10142
  bfd_vma old_offset;
10143
  int r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
10144
  reloc_bfd_fix *fix;
10145
 
10146
  if (r_type == R_XTENSA_NONE)
10147
    return TRUE;
10148
 
10149
  fix = get_bfd_fix (input_section, rel->r_offset, r_type);
10150
  if (!fix)
10151
    return TRUE;
10152
 
10153
  r_reloc_init (&r_rel, input_bfd, rel, contents,
10154
                bfd_get_section_limit (input_bfd, input_section));
10155
  old_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&r_rel);
10156
  old_offset = r_rel.target_offset;
10157
 
10158
  if (!old_sec || !r_reloc_is_defined (&r_rel))
10159
    {
10160
      if (r_type != R_XTENSA_ASM_EXPAND)
10161
        {
10162
          (*_bfd_error_handler)
10163
            (_("%B(%A+0x%lx): unexpected fix for %s relocation"),
10164
             input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
10165
             elf_howto_table[r_type].name);
10166
          return FALSE;
10167
        }
10168
      /* Leave it be.  Resolution will happen in a later stage.  */
10169
    }
10170
  else
10171
    {
10172
      sec = fix->target_sec;
10173
      rel->r_addend += ((sec->output_offset + fix->target_offset)
10174
                        - (old_sec->output_offset + old_offset));
10175
    }
10176
  return TRUE;
10177
}
10178
 
10179
 
10180
static void
10181
do_fix_for_final_link (Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
10182
                       bfd *input_bfd,
10183
                       asection *input_section,
10184
                       bfd_byte *contents,
10185
                       bfd_vma *relocationp)
10186
{
10187
  asection *sec;
10188
  int r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
10189
  reloc_bfd_fix *fix;
10190
  bfd_vma fixup_diff;
10191
 
10192
  if (r_type == R_XTENSA_NONE)
10193
    return;
10194
 
10195
  fix = get_bfd_fix (input_section, rel->r_offset, r_type);
10196
  if (!fix)
10197
    return;
10198
 
10199
  sec = fix->target_sec;
10200
 
10201
  fixup_diff = rel->r_addend;
10202
  if (elf_howto_table[fix->src_type].partial_inplace)
10203
    {
10204
      bfd_vma inplace_val;
10205
      BFD_ASSERT (fix->src_offset
10206
                  < bfd_get_section_limit (input_bfd, input_section));
10207
      inplace_val = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, &contents[fix->src_offset]);
10208
      fixup_diff += inplace_val;
10209
    }
10210
 
10211
  *relocationp = (sec->output_section->vma
10212
                  + sec->output_offset
10213
                  + fix->target_offset - fixup_diff);
10214
}
10215
 
10216
 
10217
/* Miscellaneous utility functions....  */
10218
 
10219
static asection *
10220
elf_xtensa_get_plt_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, int chunk)
10221
{
10222
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
10223
  bfd *dynobj;
10224
  char plt_name[10];
10225
 
10226
  if (chunk == 0)
10227
    {
10228
      htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
10229
      return htab->splt;
10230
    }
10231
 
10232
  dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
10233
  sprintf (plt_name, ".plt.%u", chunk);
10234
  return bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, plt_name);
10235
}
10236
 
10237
 
10238
static asection *
10239
elf_xtensa_get_gotplt_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, int chunk)
10240
{
10241
  struct elf_xtensa_link_hash_table *htab;
10242
  bfd *dynobj;
10243
  char got_name[14];
10244
 
10245
  if (chunk == 0)
10246
    {
10247
      htab = elf_xtensa_hash_table (info);
10248
      return htab->sgotplt;
10249
    }
10250
 
10251
  dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
10252
  sprintf (got_name, ".got.plt.%u", chunk);
10253
  return bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, got_name);
10254
}
10255
 
10256
 
10257
/* Get the input section for a given symbol index.
10258
   If the symbol is:
10259
   . a section symbol, return the section;
10260
   . a common symbol, return the common section;
10261
   . an undefined symbol, return the undefined section;
10262
   . an indirect symbol, follow the links;
10263
   . an absolute value, return the absolute section.  */
10264
 
10265
static asection *
10266
get_elf_r_symndx_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned long r_symndx)
10267
{
10268
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
10269
  asection *target_sec = NULL;
10270
  if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
10271
    {
10272
      Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf;
10273
      unsigned int section_index;
10274
 
10275
      isymbuf = retrieve_local_syms (abfd);
10276
      section_index = isymbuf[r_symndx].st_shndx;
10277
 
10278
      if (section_index == SHN_UNDEF)
10279
        target_sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
10280
      else if (section_index == SHN_ABS)
10281
        target_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
10282
      else if (section_index == SHN_COMMON)
10283
        target_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
10284
      else
10285
        target_sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, section_index);
10286
    }
10287
  else
10288
    {
10289
      unsigned long indx = r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
10290
      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[indx];
10291
 
10292
      while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
10293
             || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
10294
        h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
10295
 
10296
      switch (h->root.type)
10297
        {
10298
        case bfd_link_hash_defined:
10299
        case  bfd_link_hash_defweak:
10300
          target_sec = h->root.u.def.section;
10301
          break;
10302
        case bfd_link_hash_common:
10303
          target_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
10304
          break;
10305
        case bfd_link_hash_undefined:
10306
        case bfd_link_hash_undefweak:
10307
          target_sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
10308
          break;
10309
        default: /* New indirect warning.  */
10310
          target_sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
10311
          break;
10312
        }
10313
    }
10314
  return target_sec;
10315
}
10316
 
10317
 
10318
static struct elf_link_hash_entry *
10319
get_elf_r_symndx_hash_entry (bfd *abfd, unsigned long r_symndx)
10320
{
10321
  unsigned long indx;
10322
  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
10323
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
10324
 
10325
  if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
10326
    return NULL;
10327
 
10328
  indx = r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
10329
  h = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[indx];
10330
  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
10331
         || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
10332
    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
10333
  return h;
10334
}
10335
 
10336
 
10337
/* Get the section-relative offset for a symbol number.  */
10338
 
10339
static bfd_vma
10340
get_elf_r_symndx_offset (bfd *abfd, unsigned long r_symndx)
10341
{
10342
  Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
10343
  bfd_vma offset = 0;
10344
 
10345
  if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
10346
    {
10347
      Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf;
10348
      isymbuf = retrieve_local_syms (abfd);
10349
      offset = isymbuf[r_symndx].st_value;
10350
    }
10351
  else
10352
    {
10353
      unsigned long indx = r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
10354
      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h =
10355
        elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[indx];
10356
 
10357
      while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
10358
             || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
10359
        h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
10360
      if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
10361
          || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
10362
        offset = h->root.u.def.value;
10363
    }
10364
  return offset;
10365
}
10366
 
10367
 
10368
static bfd_boolean
10369
is_reloc_sym_weak (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
10370
{
10371
  unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
10372
  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
10373
 
10374
  h = get_elf_r_symndx_hash_entry (abfd, r_symndx);
10375
  if (h && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
10376
    return TRUE;
10377
  return FALSE;
10378
}
10379
 
10380
 
10381
static bfd_boolean
10382
pcrel_reloc_fits (xtensa_opcode opc,
10383
                  int opnd,
10384
                  bfd_vma self_address,
10385
                  bfd_vma dest_address)
10386
{
10387
  xtensa_isa isa = xtensa_default_isa;
10388
  uint32 valp = dest_address;
10389
  if (xtensa_operand_do_reloc (isa, opc, opnd, &valp, self_address)
10390
      || xtensa_operand_encode (isa, opc, opnd, &valp))
10391
    return FALSE;
10392
  return TRUE;
10393
}
10394
 
10395
 
10396
static bfd_boolean
10397
xtensa_is_property_section (asection *sec)
10398
{
10399
  if (xtensa_is_insntable_section (sec)
10400
      || xtensa_is_littable_section (sec)
10401
      || xtensa_is_proptable_section (sec))
10402
    return TRUE;
10403
 
10404
  return FALSE;
10405
}
10406
 
10407
 
10408
static bfd_boolean
10409
xtensa_is_insntable_section (asection *sec)
10410
{
10411
  if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, XTENSA_INSN_SEC_NAME)
10412
      || CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".gnu.linkonce.x."))
10413
    return TRUE;
10414
 
10415
  return FALSE;
10416
}
10417
 
10418
 
10419
static bfd_boolean
10420
xtensa_is_littable_section (asection *sec)
10421
{
10422
  if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, XTENSA_LIT_SEC_NAME)
10423
      || CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".gnu.linkonce.p."))
10424
    return TRUE;
10425
 
10426
  return FALSE;
10427
}
10428
 
10429
 
10430
static bfd_boolean
10431
xtensa_is_proptable_section (asection *sec)
10432
{
10433
  if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, XTENSA_PROP_SEC_NAME)
10434
      || CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".gnu.linkonce.prop."))
10435
    return TRUE;
10436
 
10437
  return FALSE;
10438
}
10439
 
10440
 
10441
static int
10442
internal_reloc_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
10443
{
10444
  const Elf_Internal_Rela *a = (const Elf_Internal_Rela *) ap;
10445
  const Elf_Internal_Rela *b = (const Elf_Internal_Rela *) bp;
10446
 
10447
  if (a->r_offset != b->r_offset)
10448
    return (a->r_offset - b->r_offset);
10449
 
10450
  /* We don't need to sort on these criteria for correctness,
10451
     but enforcing a more strict ordering prevents unstable qsort
10452
     from behaving differently with different implementations.
10453
     Without the code below we get correct but different results
10454
     on Solaris 2.7 and 2.8.  We would like to always produce the
10455
     same results no matter the host.  */
10456
 
10457
  if (a->r_info != b->r_info)
10458
    return (a->r_info - b->r_info);
10459
 
10460
  return (a->r_addend - b->r_addend);
10461
}
10462
 
10463
 
10464
static int
10465
internal_reloc_matches (const void *ap, const void *bp)
10466
{
10467
  const Elf_Internal_Rela *a = (const Elf_Internal_Rela *) ap;
10468
  const Elf_Internal_Rela *b = (const Elf_Internal_Rela *) bp;
10469
 
10470
  /* Check if one entry overlaps with the other; this shouldn't happen
10471
     except when searching for a match.  */
10472
  return (a->r_offset - b->r_offset);
10473
}
10474
 
10475
 
10476
/* Predicate function used to look up a section in a particular group.  */
10477
 
10478
static bfd_boolean
10479
match_section_group (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *sec, void *inf)
10480
{
10481
  const char *gname = inf;
10482
  const char *group_name = elf_group_name (sec);
10483
 
10484
  return (group_name == gname
10485
          || (group_name != NULL
10486
              && gname != NULL
10487
              && strcmp (group_name, gname) == 0));
10488
}
10489
 
10490
 
10491
static int linkonce_len = sizeof (".gnu.linkonce.") - 1;
10492
 
10493
static char *
10494
xtensa_property_section_name (asection *sec, const char *base_name)
10495
{
10496
  const char *suffix, *group_name;
10497
  char *prop_sec_name;
10498
 
10499
  group_name = elf_group_name (sec);
10500
  if (group_name)
10501
    {
10502
      suffix = strrchr (sec->name, '.');
10503
      if (suffix == sec->name)
10504
        suffix = 0;
10505
      prop_sec_name = (char *) bfd_malloc (strlen (base_name) + 1
10506
                                           + (suffix ? strlen (suffix) : 0));
10507
      strcpy (prop_sec_name, base_name);
10508
      if (suffix)
10509
        strcat (prop_sec_name, suffix);
10510
    }
10511
  else if (strncmp (sec->name, ".gnu.linkonce.", linkonce_len) == 0)
10512
    {
10513
      char *linkonce_kind = 0;
10514
 
10515
      if (strcmp (base_name, XTENSA_INSN_SEC_NAME) == 0)
10516
        linkonce_kind = "x.";
10517
      else if (strcmp (base_name, XTENSA_LIT_SEC_NAME) == 0)
10518
        linkonce_kind = "p.";
10519
      else if (strcmp (base_name, XTENSA_PROP_SEC_NAME) == 0)
10520
        linkonce_kind = "prop.";
10521
      else
10522
        abort ();
10523
 
10524
      prop_sec_name = (char *) bfd_malloc (strlen (sec->name)
10525
                                           + strlen (linkonce_kind) + 1);
10526
      memcpy (prop_sec_name, ".gnu.linkonce.", linkonce_len);
10527
      strcpy (prop_sec_name + linkonce_len, linkonce_kind);
10528
 
10529
      suffix = sec->name + linkonce_len;
10530
      /* For backward compatibility, replace "t." instead of inserting
10531
         the new linkonce_kind (but not for "prop" sections).  */
10532
      if (CONST_STRNEQ (suffix, "t.") && linkonce_kind[1] == '.')
10533
        suffix += 2;
10534
      strcat (prop_sec_name + linkonce_len, suffix);
10535
    }
10536
  else
10537
    prop_sec_name = strdup (base_name);
10538
 
10539
  return prop_sec_name;
10540
}
10541
 
10542
 
10543
static asection *
10544
xtensa_get_property_section (asection *sec, const char *base_name)
10545
{
10546
  char *prop_sec_name;
10547
  asection *prop_sec;
10548
 
10549
  prop_sec_name = xtensa_property_section_name (sec, base_name);
10550
  prop_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name_if (sec->owner, prop_sec_name,
10551
                                         match_section_group,
10552
                                         (void *) elf_group_name (sec));
10553
  free (prop_sec_name);
10554
  return prop_sec;
10555
}
10556
 
10557
 
10558
asection *
10559
xtensa_make_property_section (asection *sec, const char *base_name)
10560
{
10561
  char *prop_sec_name;
10562
  asection *prop_sec;
10563
 
10564
  /* Check if the section already exists.  */
10565
  prop_sec_name = xtensa_property_section_name (sec, base_name);
10566
  prop_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name_if (sec->owner, prop_sec_name,
10567
                                         match_section_group,
10568
                                         (void *) elf_group_name (sec));
10569
  /* If not, create it.  */
10570
  if (! prop_sec)
10571
    {
10572
      flagword flags = (SEC_RELOC | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_READONLY);
10573
      flags |= (bfd_get_section_flags (sec->owner, sec)
10574
                & (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES));
10575
 
10576
      prop_sec = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags
10577
        (sec->owner, strdup (prop_sec_name), flags);
10578
      if (! prop_sec)
10579
        return 0;
10580
 
10581
      elf_group_name (prop_sec) = elf_group_name (sec);
10582
    }
10583
 
10584
  free (prop_sec_name);
10585
  return prop_sec;
10586
}
10587
 
10588
 
10589
flagword
10590
xtensa_get_property_predef_flags (asection *sec)
10591
{
10592
  if (xtensa_is_insntable_section (sec))
10593
    return (XTENSA_PROP_INSN
10594
            | XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM
10595
            | XTENSA_PROP_INSN_NO_REORDER);
10596
 
10597
  if (xtensa_is_littable_section (sec))
10598
    return (XTENSA_PROP_LITERAL
10599
            | XTENSA_PROP_NO_TRANSFORM
10600
            | XTENSA_PROP_INSN_NO_REORDER);
10601
 
10602
  return 0;
10603
}
10604
 
10605
 
10606
/* Other functions called directly by the linker.  */
10607
 
10608
bfd_boolean
10609
xtensa_callback_required_dependence (bfd *abfd,
10610
                                     asection *sec,
10611
                                     struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
10612
                                     deps_callback_t callback,
10613
                                     void *closure)
10614
{
10615
  Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
10616
  bfd_byte *contents;
10617
  unsigned i;
10618
  bfd_boolean ok = TRUE;
10619
  bfd_size_type sec_size;
10620
 
10621
  sec_size = bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, sec);
10622
 
10623
  /* ".plt*" sections have no explicit relocations but they contain L32R
10624
     instructions that reference the corresponding ".got.plt*" sections.  */
10625
  if ((sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
10626
      && CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".plt"))
10627
    {
10628
      asection *sgotplt;
10629
 
10630
      /* Find the corresponding ".got.plt*" section.  */
10631
      if (sec->name[4] == '\0')
10632
        sgotplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (sec->owner, ".got.plt");
10633
      else
10634
        {
10635
          char got_name[14];
10636
          int chunk = 0;
10637
 
10638
          BFD_ASSERT (sec->name[4] == '.');
10639
          chunk = strtol (&sec->name[5], NULL, 10);
10640
 
10641
          sprintf (got_name, ".got.plt.%u", chunk);
10642
          sgotplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (sec->owner, got_name);
10643
        }
10644
      BFD_ASSERT (sgotplt);
10645
 
10646
      /* Assume worst-case offsets: L32R at the very end of the ".plt"
10647
         section referencing a literal at the very beginning of
10648
         ".got.plt".  This is very close to the real dependence, anyway.  */
10649
      (*callback) (sec, sec_size, sgotplt, 0, closure);
10650
    }
10651
 
10652
  /* Only ELF files are supported for Xtensa.  Check here to avoid a segfault
10653
     when building uclibc, which runs "ld -b binary /dev/null".  */
10654
  if (bfd_get_flavour (abfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
10655
    return ok;
10656
 
10657
  internal_relocs = retrieve_internal_relocs (abfd, sec,
10658
                                              link_info->keep_memory);
10659
  if (internal_relocs == NULL
10660
      || sec->reloc_count == 0)
10661
    return ok;
10662
 
10663
  /* Cache the contents for the duration of this scan.  */
10664
  contents = retrieve_contents (abfd, sec, link_info->keep_memory);
10665
  if (contents == NULL && sec_size != 0)
10666
    {
10667
      ok = FALSE;
10668
      goto error_return;
10669
    }
10670
 
10671
  if (!xtensa_default_isa)
10672
    xtensa_default_isa = xtensa_isa_init (0, 0);
10673
 
10674
  for (i = 0; i < sec->reloc_count; i++)
10675
    {
10676
      Elf_Internal_Rela *irel = &internal_relocs[i];
10677
      if (is_l32r_relocation (abfd, sec, contents, irel))
10678
        {
10679
          r_reloc l32r_rel;
10680
          asection *target_sec;
10681
          bfd_vma target_offset;
10682
 
10683
          r_reloc_init (&l32r_rel, abfd, irel, contents, sec_size);
10684
          target_sec = NULL;
10685
          target_offset = 0;
10686
          /* L32Rs must be local to the input file.  */
10687
          if (r_reloc_is_defined (&l32r_rel))
10688
            {
10689
              target_sec = r_reloc_get_section (&l32r_rel);
10690
              target_offset = l32r_rel.target_offset;
10691
            }
10692
          (*callback) (sec, irel->r_offset, target_sec, target_offset,
10693
                       closure);
10694
        }
10695
    }
10696
 
10697
 error_return:
10698
  release_internal_relocs (sec, internal_relocs);
10699
  release_contents (sec, contents);
10700
  return ok;
10701
}
10702
 
10703
/* The default literal sections should always be marked as "code" (i.e.,
10704
   SHF_EXECINSTR).  This is particularly important for the Linux kernel
10705
   module loader so that the literals are not placed after the text.  */
10706
static const struct bfd_elf_special_section elf_xtensa_special_sections[] =
10707
{
10708
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini.literal"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
10709
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init.literal"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
10710
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".literal"),      0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
10711
  { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".xtensa.info"),  0, SHT_NOTE,     0 },
10712
  { NULL,                       0,      0, 0,            0 }
10713
};
10714
 
10715
#ifndef ELF_ARCH
10716
#define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM               bfd_elf32_xtensa_le_vec
10717
#define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME              "elf32-xtensa-le"
10718
#define TARGET_BIG_SYM                  bfd_elf32_xtensa_be_vec
10719
#define TARGET_BIG_NAME                 "elf32-xtensa-be"
10720
#define ELF_ARCH                        bfd_arch_xtensa
10721
 
10722
#define ELF_MACHINE_CODE                EM_XTENSA
10723
#define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1                EM_XTENSA_OLD
10724
 
10725
#if XCHAL_HAVE_MMU
10726
#define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE                 (1 << XCHAL_MMU_MIN_PTE_PAGE_SIZE)
10727
#else /* !XCHAL_HAVE_MMU */
10728
#define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE                 1
10729
#endif /* !XCHAL_HAVE_MMU */
10730
#endif /* ELF_ARCH */
10731
 
10732
#define elf_backend_can_gc_sections     1
10733
#define elf_backend_can_refcount        1
10734
#define elf_backend_plt_readonly        1
10735
#define elf_backend_got_header_size     4
10736
#define elf_backend_want_dynbss         0
10737
#define elf_backend_want_got_plt        1
10738
 
10739
#define elf_info_to_howto                    elf_xtensa_info_to_howto_rela
10740
 
10741
#define bfd_elf32_mkobject                   elf_xtensa_mkobject
10742
 
10743
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data elf_xtensa_merge_private_bfd_data
10744
#define bfd_elf32_new_section_hook           elf_xtensa_new_section_hook
10745
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_print_private_bfd_data elf_xtensa_print_private_bfd_data
10746
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section          elf_xtensa_relax_section
10747
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup      elf_xtensa_reloc_type_lookup
10748
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup \
10749
  elf_xtensa_reloc_name_lookup
10750
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags      elf_xtensa_set_private_flags
10751
#define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create elf_xtensa_link_hash_table_create
10752
 
10753
#define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol    elf_xtensa_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10754
#define elf_backend_check_relocs             elf_xtensa_check_relocs
10755
#define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections  elf_xtensa_create_dynamic_sections
10756
#define elf_backend_discard_info             elf_xtensa_discard_info
10757
#define elf_backend_ignore_discarded_relocs  elf_xtensa_ignore_discarded_relocs
10758
#define elf_backend_final_write_processing   elf_xtensa_final_write_processing
10759
#define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections  elf_xtensa_finish_dynamic_sections
10760
#define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol    elf_xtensa_finish_dynamic_symbol
10761
#define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook             elf_xtensa_gc_mark_hook
10762
#define elf_backend_gc_sweep_hook            elf_xtensa_gc_sweep_hook
10763
#define elf_backend_grok_prstatus            elf_xtensa_grok_prstatus
10764
#define elf_backend_grok_psinfo              elf_xtensa_grok_psinfo
10765
#define elf_backend_hide_symbol              elf_xtensa_hide_symbol
10766
#define elf_backend_object_p                 elf_xtensa_object_p
10767
#define elf_backend_reloc_type_class         elf_xtensa_reloc_type_class
10768
#define elf_backend_relocate_section         elf_xtensa_relocate_section
10769
#define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections    elf_xtensa_size_dynamic_sections
10770
#define elf_backend_always_size_sections     elf_xtensa_always_size_sections
10771
#define elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym \
10772
  ((bfd_boolean (*) (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, asection *)) bfd_true)
10773
#define elf_backend_special_sections         elf_xtensa_special_sections
10774
#define elf_backend_action_discarded         elf_xtensa_action_discarded
10775
#define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol     elf_xtensa_copy_indirect_symbol
10776
 
10777
#include "elf32-target.h"

powered by: WebSVN 2.1.0

© copyright 1999-2024 OpenCores.org, equivalent to Oliscience, all rights reserved. OpenCores®, registered trademark.